blob: d28de2fab94f51387793311ec5960e9d898badaa [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Faulet553dee32021-07-07 16:46:09 +02007 2021/07/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200817 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
818 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
819 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
820
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200821 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
822 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
823
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200824 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
825 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
826 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
827 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
828
829 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
830 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
831 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
832 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
833
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200834Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100835
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
837 listen mwcli_px
838 bind :1111
839 ...
840 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100841
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200842 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
843 bind :80
844 .endif
845
846 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200847 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200848 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200849 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .endif
851
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200852 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
853 profiling.memory on
854 .endif
855
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200856Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100857
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200858 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
860 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
861 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
862
863Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
864"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
865fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
866provide advice to the user.
867
868Example:
869
870 .if "${A}"
871 .if "${B}"
872 .notice "A=1, B=1"
873 .elif "${C}"
874 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
875 .elif "${D}"
876 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
877 .else
878 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
879 .endif
880 .else
881 .notice "A=0"
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200884 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
885 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
886
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100887
8882.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200889----------------
890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100891Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100892values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
893otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
894numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
895for every keyword. Supported units are :
896
897 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
898 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
899 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
900 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
901 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
902 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
903
904
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009052.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200906-------------
907
908 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
909 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
910 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
911 global
912 daemon
913 maxconn 256
914
915 defaults
916 mode http
917 timeout connect 5000ms
918 timeout client 50000ms
919 timeout server 50000ms
920
921 frontend http-in
922 bind *:80
923 default_backend servers
924
925 backend servers
926 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
927
928
929 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
930 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
931 global
932 daemon
933 maxconn 256
934
935 defaults
936 mode http
937 timeout connect 5000ms
938 timeout client 50000ms
939 timeout server 50000ms
940
941 listen http-in
942 bind *:80
943 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
944
945
946Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
947
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100948 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200949
950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009513. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952--------------------
953
954Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
955are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
956of them have command-line equivalents.
957
958The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
959
960 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200961 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200964 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200966 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - description
968 - deviceatlas-json-file
969 - deviceatlas-log-level
970 - deviceatlas-separator
971 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200972 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900973 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974 - gid
975 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100976 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200977 - h1-case-adjust
978 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100979 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100980 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100981 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +0200982 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200983 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200985 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100986 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200987 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100988 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100989 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200990 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200992 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200993 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100994 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200996 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100997 - presetenv
998 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999 - uid
1000 - ulimit-n
1001 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001002 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001003 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001004 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001005 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001006 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001007 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001008 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - ssl-default-bind-options
1010 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001011 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001012 - ssl-default-server-options
1013 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001014 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001015 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001016 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001017 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001018 - 51degrees-data-file
1019 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001020 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001021 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001022 - wurfl-data-file
1023 - wurfl-information-list
1024 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001025 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001026 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001029 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001030 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001031 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001032 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001033 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001034 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001035 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001036 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001037 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001038 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - noepoll
1041 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001042 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001044 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001045 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001046 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001047 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001048 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001049 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001050 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001051 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001052 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001053 - tune.buffers.limit
1054 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001055 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001056 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001057 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001058 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001059 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001060 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001061 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001062 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001063 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001064 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001065 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001066 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001067 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001068 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001069 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1070 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001071 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001072 - tune.maxaccept
1073 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001074 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001075 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001076 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001077 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1078 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001079 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1080 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001081 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001082 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001083 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001084 - tune.sndbuf.client
1085 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001086 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001087 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001088 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001089 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001090 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001091 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001092 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001093 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001094 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001095 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001096 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1097 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1098 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001099 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1100 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001104 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105
1106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108------------------------------------
1109
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001110ca-base <dir>
1111 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001112 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1113 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1114 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001115
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116chroot <jail dir>
1117 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1118 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1119 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1120 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1121 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001122 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001123
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001124cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1125 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1126 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1127 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1128 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1129 set. These sets have the format
1130
1131 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1132
1133 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001135 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1136 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001137 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1138 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001139 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1140 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1141 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1142 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1143 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1144 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1145 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1146 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1147 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1148 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001149
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001150 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1151 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1152 on the machine's word size.
1153
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001154 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001155 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1156 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1157 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1158 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1159 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1160 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001161
1162 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001163 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1164
1165 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1166 # first 4 CPUs
1167
1168 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1169 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1170 # word size.
1171
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001172 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001173 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001174 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1175 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1176 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1177
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001178 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1179 # and so on.
1180 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1181 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1182 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1183
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001184 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001185 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1186 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1187 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1188
1189 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1190 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1191 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1192
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1194 # and a thread range.
1195 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1196 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1197 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1198
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001199crt-base <dir>
1200 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001201 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1202 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001204daemon
1205 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1206 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001207 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1208 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001209
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001210default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001211 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001212 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1213 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1214 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1215 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1216 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1217 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1218 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1219 not start with a slash ('/'):
1220 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1221 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1222
1223 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1224 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1225 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1226 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1227 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1228 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1229 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1230 each of them.
1231
1232 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1233 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1234 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1235 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1236 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1237 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1238 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1239 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1240
1241 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1242 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001243 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001244 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1245 made easily relocatable.
1246
1247 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1248 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1249 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1250 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1251 consistent across all configuration files.
1252
1253 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1254 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1255 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1256 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1257 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1258 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1259 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1260 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1261
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001262deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1263 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001264 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001265
1266deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001267 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001268 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1269
1270deviceatlas-separator <char>
1271 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1272 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1273
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001274deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001275 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1276 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1277 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001278
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001279expose-experimental-directives
1280 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1281 the config file will be rejected.
1282
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001283external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001284 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1285 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001286 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1287 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1288 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1289 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1290 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001291
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001292gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001293 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1295 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001296 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001297 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001298 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001299
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001300group <group name>
1301 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1302 See also "gid" and "user".
1303
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001304hard-stop-after <time>
1305 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1306
1307 Arguments :
1308 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1309 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1310 SIGUSR1 signal.
1311
1312 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1313 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1314 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1315
1316 Example:
1317 global
1318 hard-stop-after 30s
1319
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001320h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1321 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1322 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1323 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1324 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001325 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001326 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1327 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1328 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1329 specified in a proxy.
1330
1331 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1332 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1333 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1334 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1335 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1336 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1337 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1338
1339 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1340 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1341 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1342 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1343 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1344
1345 Example:
1346 global
1347 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1348
1349 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1350 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1351
1352h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1353 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1354 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1355 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1356 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1357 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1358 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1359 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1360 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1361
1362 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1363 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1364 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1365
1366 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1367 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1368
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001369insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001370 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001371 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1372 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1373 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1374 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1375 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1376 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1377 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001378 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1380 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1381 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1382 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1383 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1384 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1385 disable it.
1386
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001387insecure-setuid-wanted
1388 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1389 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1390 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1391 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001392 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001393 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001394 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001395 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1396 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001397 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001398 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1399 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1400 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1401 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1402
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001403issuers-chain-path <dir>
1404 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1405 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1406 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001407 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001408 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1409 "issuers-chain-path".
1410 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1411 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1412 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1413 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1414 will share the chain in memory.
1415
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001416h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1417 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1418 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1419 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1420 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1421 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1422 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1423 the keyword with "no'.
1424
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001425localpeer <name>
1426 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1427 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1428 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1429 the configuration parsing.
1430
1431 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1432 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1433
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001434log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001435 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001436 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001437 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001438 configured with "log global".
1439
1440 <address> can be one of:
1441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001442 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001443 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1444 port).
1445
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001446 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1447 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1448 port).
1449
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001450 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001451 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1452 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001453 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001454
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001455 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1456 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1457 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1458 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1459 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1460 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1461 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1462 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1463 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1464 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001465 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001466 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1467 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1468 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001469 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1470 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001471
1472 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1473 "fd@2", see above.
1474
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001475 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1476 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1477 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1478 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1479 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1480
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001481 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1482 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001483
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001484 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1485 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1486 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1487 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1488 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1489 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1490 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1491 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1492 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1493 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001494 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1495 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001496
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001497 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1498 one of the following :
1499
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001500 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1501 field is stripped. This is the default.
1502 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1503 rfc3164.
1504
1505 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001506 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1507
1508 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1509 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1510
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001511 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1512 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1513 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1514 designed to be used with a local log server.
1515
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001516 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1517 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1518 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1519 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1520 logger consumes.
1521
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001522 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1523 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1524 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1525 used with a local log server.
1526
1527 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1528 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1529 designed to be used with a local log server.
1530
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001531 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1532 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1533 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1534 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1535
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001536 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1537 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1538 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1539 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1540 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1541
1542 <sample_size>
1543 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1544 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1545 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1546 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1547 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1548
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001549 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001550
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001551 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1552 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1553 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1554
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001555 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1556 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1557 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1558 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001559
1560 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001561 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1562 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1563 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1564 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1565 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1566 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001568 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001570log-send-hostname [<string>]
1571 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1572 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1573 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1574 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1575 the logs.
1576
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001577log-tag <string>
1578 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1579 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1580 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001581 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001582
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001583lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001584 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1585 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1586 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1587 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1588 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1589 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001590 used multiple times.
1591
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001592lua-load-per-thread <file>
1593 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1594 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1595 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1596 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1597 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1598 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1599 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1600 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1601 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1602 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1603 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1604 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1605 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1606 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1607 times.
1608
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001609lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1610 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1611 variable.
1612 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1613 to "path".
1614
1615 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1616 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1617 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1618 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1619 will be checked earlier.
1620
1621 As an example by specifying the following path:
1622
1623 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1624 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1625
1626 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1627 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1628 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1629 paths if that does not exist either.
1630
1631 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1632 documentation.
1633
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001634master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001635 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1636 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1637 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001638 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001639 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1640 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001641 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1642 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1643 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1644 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1645 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001646
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001647 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001648
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001649mworker-max-reloads <number>
1650 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001651 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001652 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1653 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1654 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1655
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001656nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001657 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1658 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1659 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001660 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1661 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001662 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1663 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1664 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001665
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001666nbthread <number>
1667 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001668 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001669 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1670 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1671 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1672 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001673 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1674 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1675 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1676 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1677 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1678 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1679 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001680
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001681numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001682 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001683 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1684 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1685 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1686 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1687 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1688 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1689 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1690 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001693 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1694 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1695 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1696 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001697
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001698pp2-never-send-local
1699 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1700 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1701 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1702 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1703 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1704 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1705 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1706 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1707 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1708 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1709 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1710
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001711presetenv <name> <value>
1712 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1713 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1714 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1715 and "unsetenv".
1716
1717resetenv [<name> ...]
1718 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1719 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1720 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1721 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1722 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1723 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1724 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1725 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1726
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001727stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001728 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1729 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1730 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1731 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1732 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1733 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001734 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001735 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1736 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1737 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1738 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001739
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001740server-state-base <directory>
1741 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001742 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1743 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001744
1745server-state-file <file>
1746 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1747 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1748 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1749 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1750 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1751 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1752 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1753 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001754 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1755 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001756
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001757set-var <var-name> <expr>
1758 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1759 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1760 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1761 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1762 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1763 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1764 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1765 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1766 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1767
1768 Example:
1769 global
1770 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1771 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1772 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1773
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001774setenv <name> <value>
1775 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1776 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1777 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1778 and "unsetenv".
1779
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001780set-dumpable
1781 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001782 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1783 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1784 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1785 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1786 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1787 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1788 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1789 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1790 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1791 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1792 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1793 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1794 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1795 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1796 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001797 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001798 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001799
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001800ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1802 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001803 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001804 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001805 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1806 information and recommendations see e.g.
1807 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1808 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1809 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1810 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001811
1812ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1814 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1815 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1816 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1817 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001818 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1819 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1820 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001821 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001822
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001823ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1825 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1826 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1827 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1828 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1829
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001830ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1832 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1833 keyword to see available options.
1834
1835 Example:
1836 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001837 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001838
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001839ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1841 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001842 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001843 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001844 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1845 information and recommendations see e.g.
1846 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1847 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1848 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1849 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1850 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851
1852ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1854 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1855 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1856 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1857 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001858 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1859 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1860 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1861 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001862
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001863ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1865 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1866 keyword to see available options.
1867
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1869 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1870 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1871 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001872 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001873 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001874 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1875 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1876 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1877 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001878 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1879 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1880 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1881
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001882ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1883 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1884 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001885 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001886 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001887 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1888
1889 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001890
1891 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1892 and won't try to remove them.
1893
1894 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1895
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001896ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001897 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001898 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1899 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1900 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1903 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1904 optimize the startup time.
1905
1906 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1907 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1908 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1909
1910 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001911 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001912
1913 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001914 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1915 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001916
1917 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1918 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1919 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1920 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1921 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001922 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001923
1924 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001925 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001926 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1927 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1928 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1929 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1930 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001931 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001932
1933 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1934
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001935 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001936 a cert bundle.
1937
1938 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1939 separately in several "crt".
1940
1941 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1942 since files are loading separately.
1943
1944 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1945 required to commit them.
1946
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001947 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001948 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001949
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001950 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1951 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1952 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001953
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001954 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1955 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1956 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001957
1958 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001959 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1960 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001962 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1963 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1964
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001965 The default behavior is "all".
1966
1967 Example:
1968 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1969 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1970 ssl-load-extra-files none
1971
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001972 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1973 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001974
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001975ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1976 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1977 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1978 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1979
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001980ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001981 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001982 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1983 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1984 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1985 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1986 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1987 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001988 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001989
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001990stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1991 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1992 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1993 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001994 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001995 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001996
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001997 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1998 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1999 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002000
2001stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2002 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2003 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002004 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002005
2006stats maxconn <connections>
2007 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2008 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2009
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002010uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002011 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002012 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2013 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2014 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2015
2016ulimit-n <number>
2017 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2018 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2019 option.
2020
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002021unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2022 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2023
2024 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2025 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2026 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2027 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2028 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002029 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002030 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2031 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2032 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2033 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2034
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002035unsetenv [<name> ...]
2036 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2037 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2038 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2039 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2040 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2041 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2042 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2043
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002044user <user name>
2045 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2046 See also "uid" and "group".
2047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002048node <name>
2049 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2050
2051 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2052 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2053 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2054 traffic.
2055
2056description <text>
2057 Add a text that describes the instance.
2058
2059 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2060 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2061 "<" and ">" characters.
2062
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100206351degrees-data-file <file path>
2064 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002065 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002066
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002067 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002068 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2069
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000207051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002071 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2072 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2073 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200207851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002079 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2080 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2081
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002082 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002083 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2084
208551degrees-cache-size <number>
2086 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2087 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2088 By default, this cache is disabled.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002091 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2092
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002093wurfl-data-file <file path>
2094 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2095 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2096
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002097 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002098 with USE_WURFL=1.
2099
2100wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2101 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2102 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2103 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2104
2105 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2106
2107 Valid WURFL properties are:
2108 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2109
2110 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2111 device.
2112
2113 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2114 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2115
2116 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2117 particular web request.
2118
2119 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2120 used Libwurfl API version.
2121
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002122 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2123 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2124
2125 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2126 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2127
2128 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002131 with USE_WURFL=1.
2132
2133wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2134 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2135 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2136
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002138 with USE_WURFL=1.
2139
2140wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2141 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2142 thus before the chroot.
2143
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002144 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002145 with USE_WURFL=1.
2146
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002147wurfl-cache-size <size>
2148 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2149 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002150 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002151 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002152
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002154 with USE_WURFL=1.
2155
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002156strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002157 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002158 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2159 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002160 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002161 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021633.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002164-----------------------
2165
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002166busy-polling
2167 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2168 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2169 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2170 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2171 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2172 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2173 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2174 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2175 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2176 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2177 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2178 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2179 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2180 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2181 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2182 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2183 "poll" pollers.
2184
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002185 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2186 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2187 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2188
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002189max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002190 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002191 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2192 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2193 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2194 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2195 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2196 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2197 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2198
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002199maxconn <number>
2200 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2201 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2202 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002203 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2204 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2205 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2206 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002207 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2208 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2209 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2210 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2211 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2212 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002213
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002214maxconnrate <number>
2215 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2216 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2217 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2218 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2219 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2220 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2221 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2222 fairness.
2223
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002224maxcomprate <number>
2225 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002226 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002227 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2228 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2229 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002230 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002231 default value.
2232
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002233maxcompcpuusage <number>
2234 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2235 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2236 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002237 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002238 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2239 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2240 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2241 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2242
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002243maxpipes <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2245 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2246 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2247 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2248 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2249 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2250
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002251maxsessrate <number>
2252 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2253 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2254 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2255 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2256 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2257 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2258 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2259 fairness.
2260
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002261maxsslconn <number>
2262 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2263 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2264 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2265 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2266 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2267 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2268 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002269 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2270 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2271 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2272 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002273 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002274 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2275 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002276
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002277maxsslrate <number>
2278 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2279 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2280 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2281 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2282 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2283 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2284 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2285 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2286 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2287 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2288
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002289maxzlibmem <number>
2290 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2291 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2292 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002293 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2294 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2295 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002297noepoll
2298 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2299 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002300 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301
2302nokqueue
2303 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2304 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2305 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2306
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002307noevports
2308 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2309 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2310 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2311 also "nopoll".
2312
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002313nopoll
2314 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2315 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002316 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002317 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2318 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002320nosplice
2321 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002322 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002323 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002324 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002325 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2326 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2327 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2328 "option splice-response".
2329
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002330nogetaddrinfo
2331 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2332 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2333
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002334noreuseport
2335 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2336 command line argument "-dR".
2337
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002338profiling.memory { on | off }
2339 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2340 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2341 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2342 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2343 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2344 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2345 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2346 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2347 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2348
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002349profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2350 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2351 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2352 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2353 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002354 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002355 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2356 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2357 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2358 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2359
2360 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2361 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2362 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2363 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2364 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002365 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2366 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2367 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2368 CLI.
2369
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002370spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002371 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2372 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2373 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2374 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2375 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2376 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002379 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002380 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002381 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002382 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002383 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2384 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2385 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002386 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2387 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002388 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2389 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2390 openssl configuration file uses:
2391 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2392
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002393ssl-mode-async
2394 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002395 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002396 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2397 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002398 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002399 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002400 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002401
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002402tune.buffers.limit <number>
2403 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2404 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2405 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2406 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2407 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002408 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002409 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2410 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2411 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2412 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2413 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2414 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2415 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2416 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002417 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002418
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002419tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2420 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2421 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2422 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002424
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002425tune.bufsize <number>
2426 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2427 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2428 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2429 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2430 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2431 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2432 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002433 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2434 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002435 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002436 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002437 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002438 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2439 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002440
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002441tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2442 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002443
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002444tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2445 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2446 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2447 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2448 this value. The default value is 1.
2449
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002450tune.fail-alloc
2451 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2452 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2453 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2454 gracefully.
2455
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002456tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2457 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2458 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2459 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2460 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2461 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2462
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002463tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2464 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2465 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2466 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2467 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2468 change it.
2469
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002470tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2471 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002472 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002473 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002474 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2475 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2476 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2477 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2478 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2479
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002480tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2481 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2482 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2483 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2484 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2485 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002486 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002487 recommended not to change this value.
2488
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002489tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002490 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002491 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002492 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002493 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2494 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2495 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2496 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2497
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002498tune.http.cookielen <number>
2499 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2500 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2501 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2502 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2503 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2504 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2505 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2506 to change this value.
2507
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002508tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002509 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2510 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002511 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002512 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002513 configuration directives too.
2514 The default value is 1024.
2515
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002516tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2517 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2518 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2519 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2520 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2521 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2522 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002523 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2524 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2525 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002526
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002527tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2528 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2529 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2530 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2531 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2532 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2533 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002534 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2535 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2536 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2537 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2538 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002539
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002540tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002541 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002542 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2543 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2544 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2545 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002546 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002547 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002548 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002549 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2550
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002551tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2552 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2553 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2554 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2555 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2556 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2557 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2558 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2559 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2560 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2561
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002562tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2563 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002564 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002565 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2566 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002567 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002568 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2569 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2570
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002571tune.lua.maxmem
2572 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2573 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2574 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2575 memory.
2576
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002577tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2578 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002579 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2580 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002581 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002582
2583tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2584 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2585 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2586 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2587 check servers.
2588
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002589tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2590 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2591 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2592 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002593 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002594
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002595tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002596 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2597 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002598 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2599 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2600 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2601 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2602 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2603 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2604 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2605 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2606 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002607
2608tune.maxpollevents <number>
2609 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2610 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2611 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2612 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2613 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2614
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002615tune.maxrewrite <number>
2616 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2617 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2618 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2619 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2620 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2621 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2622 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2623 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2624 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2625 bufsize.
2626
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002627tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2628 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2629 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2630 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2631 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2632 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2633 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2634 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2635 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2636 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002637 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2638 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002639 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2640 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2641 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2642 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2643 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2644 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2645 setting this parameter to 0.
2646
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002647tune.pipesize <number>
2648 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2649 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2650 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2651 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2652 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2653 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2654
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002655tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2656 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002657 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002658 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2659 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2660 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2661 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002662 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002663
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002664tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2665 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002666 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002667 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2668 default is 20.
2669
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002670tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2671tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2672 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2673 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2674 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002675 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002676 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002677 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2678 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2679
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002680tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002681 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002682 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2683 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2684 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2685 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2686
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002687tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002688 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002689 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2690 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2691 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2692 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2693 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2694 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2695 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002696
2697tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2698 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002699 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002700 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2701 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2702 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2703 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2704 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2705 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2706 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002707
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002708tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2709tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2710 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2711 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2712 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002713 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002714 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002715 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2716 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2717 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2718 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002719 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002720
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002721tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002722 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002723 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2724 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2725 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2726 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2727 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2728 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2729 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2730 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2731 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2732 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2733 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002734
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002735tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002736 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002737 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2738 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2739 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2740 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2741 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2742
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002743tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2744 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2745 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2746 performances. This is disabled by default.
2747
2748 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2749 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2750
2751 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2752
2753 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2754
2755 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2756
2757 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2758 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2759 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2760
2761 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2762 converted.
2763
2764 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2765 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2766 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2767 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2768 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2769 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2770 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002771 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2772 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002773
2774 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2775
2776 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2777 only need this line:
2778
2779 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2780
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002781tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2782 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002783 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002784 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2785 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2786 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2787 being used for too long.
2788
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002789tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2790 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2791 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2792 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2793 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2794 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2795 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2796 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2797 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2798 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2799 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002800 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002801 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002802
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002803tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2804 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2805 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2806 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2807 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002808 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002809 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2810 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002811 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2812 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002813
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002814tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2815 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2816 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2817 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2818 1000 entries.
2819
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002820tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2821 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2822 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2823 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2824
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002825tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002826tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002827tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2828tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2829tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002830 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2831 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2832 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2833 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2834 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2835 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2836 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2837 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002838
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002839 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2840 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2841 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2842 all available space is consumed.
2843 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2844 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2845 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002846
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002847tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2848 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002849 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002850 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002851 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002852 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2853
2854tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2855 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2856 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002857 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2858 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028603.3. Debugging
2861--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002862
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002863quiet
2864 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2865 line argument "-q".
2866
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002867zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002868 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002869 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2870 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2871 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2872 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2873 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2874
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028763.4. Userlists
2877--------------
2878It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2879http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2880it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2881
2882userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002883 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002884 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2885
2886group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002887 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002888 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2889 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2890
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002891user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2892 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002893 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2894 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002895 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2896 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2897 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2898 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002899
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002900 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2901 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2902 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2903 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2904 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2905 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2906 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002907 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002908 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
2910 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002911 userlist L1
2912 group G1 users tiger,scott
2913 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002915 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2916 user scott insecure-password elgato
2917 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002918
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002919 userlist L2
2920 group G1
2921 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002923 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2924 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2925 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002926
2927 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002928
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002929
29303.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002931----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002932It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002933several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002934instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2935values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2936automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2937In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2938using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2939tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2940reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2941Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2942that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2943each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002944
2945peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002946 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002947 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2948
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002949bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2950 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2951 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2952
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002953disabled
2954 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2955 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2956 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2957
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002958default-bind [param*]
2959 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2960
2961default-server [param*]
2962 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2963
2964 Arguments:
2965 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2966 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2967 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2968 details.
2969
2970
2971 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2972
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002973enable
2974 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2975
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002976log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002977 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2978 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2979 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2980 more details.
2981
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002982peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002983 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2984 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002985 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002986 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002987 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2988 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2989 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002990
2991 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2992 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2993
2994 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002995 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2996 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2997 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002998
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002999 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3000 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003001
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003002 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3003 "server" keyword explanation below).
3004
3005server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003006 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003007 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3008 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3009 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3010 of this "peers" section).
3011 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3012
3013
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003014 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003015 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003016 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003017 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3018 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3019 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003020
3021 backend mybackend
3022 mode tcp
3023 balance roundrobin
3024 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3025 stick on src
3026
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003027 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3028 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003029
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003030 Example:
3031 peers mypeers
3032 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3033 default-server ssl verify none
3034 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3035 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003036
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003037
3038table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3039 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3040
3041 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3042 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003043 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003044 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3045 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3046 "stick-table" keyword).
3047
3048 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3049 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3050 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3051 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3052 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3053 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3054 of the stick-table name as follows:
3055
3056 peers mypeers
3057 peer A ...
3058 peer B ...
3059 table t1 ...
3060
3061 frontend fe1
3062 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3063
3064 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3065 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3066
3067 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3068 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3069 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3070 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3071 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3072 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3073 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3074
3075 peers mypeers
3076 peer A ...
3077 peer B ...
3078 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3079
3080 backend t1
3081 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3082
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003083 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003084 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3085 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3086
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030873.6. Mailers
3088------------
3089It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3090If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3091in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3092
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003093mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003094 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3095 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3096
3097mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3098 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3099
3100 Example:
3101 mailers mymailers
3102 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3103 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3104
3105 backend mybackend
3106 mode tcp
3107 balance roundrobin
3108
3109 email-alert mailers mymailers
3110 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3111 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3112
3113 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3114 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3115
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003116timeout mail <time>
3117 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3118 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3119 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3120 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3121
3122 Example:
3123 mailers mymailers
3124 timeout mail 20s
3125 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003126
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031273.7. Programs
3128-------------
3129In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3130master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3131managed the same way as the workers.
3132
3133During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3134sequence as a worker:
3135
3136 - the master is re-executed
3137 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3138 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3139 instance of the program
3140
3141During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3142
3143program <name>
3144 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3145 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3146 the management guide).
3147
3148command <command> [arguments*]
3149 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3150 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3151 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3152 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3153
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003154user <user name>
3155 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3156 See also "group".
3157
3158group <group name>
3159 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3160 See also "user".
3161
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003162option start-on-reload
3163no option start-on-reload
3164 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3165 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3166 program section.
3167
3168
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031693.8. HTTP-errors
3170----------------
3171
3172It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3173imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3174several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3175
3176http-errors <name>
3177 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3178 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3179
3180errorfile <code> <file>
3181 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3182
3183 Arguments :
3184 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003185 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003186 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003187
3188 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3189 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3190 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3191 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3192 before any chroot is performed.
3193
3194 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3195
3196 Example:
3197 http-errors website-1
3198 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3199 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3200 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3201
3202 http-errors website-2
3203 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3204 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3205 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3206
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032073.9. Rings
3208----------
3209
3210It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3211servers or traces.
3212
3213ring <ringname>
3214 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3215
3216description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003217 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003218 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3219
3220format <format>
3221 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3222
3223 Arguments:
3224 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3225 one of the following :
3226
3227 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3228 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3229 designed to be used with a local log server.
3230
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003231 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3232 field is stripped. This is the default.
3233 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3234 rfc3164.
3235
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003236 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3237 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3238 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3239 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3240 is the default.
3241
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003242 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003243 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3244
3245 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3246 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3247
3248 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3249 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3250 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3251 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3252 logger consumes.
3253
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003254 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3255 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3256 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3257 with a local log server.
3258
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003259 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3260 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3261 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3262 used with a local log server.
3263
3264maxlen <length>
3265 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3266 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3267 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3268
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003269server <name> <address> [param*]
3270 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3271 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3272 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3273 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3274 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3275 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3276 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3277 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3278 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003279 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3280 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003281
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003282size <size>
3283 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3284 set to BUFSIZE.
3285
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003286timeout connect <timeout>
3287 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3288
3289 Arguments :
3290 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3291 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3292 as explained at the top of this document.
3293
3294timeout server <timeout>
3295 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3296
3297 Arguments :
3298 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3299 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3300 as explained at the top of this document.
3301
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003302 Example:
3303 global
3304 log ring@myring local7
3305
3306 ring myring
3307 description "My local buffer"
3308 format rfc3164
3309 maxlen 1200
3310 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003311 timeout connect 5s
3312 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003313 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003314
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033153.10. Log forwarding
3316-------------------
3317
3318It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003319HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003320
3321log-forward <name>
3322 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3323
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003324backlog <conns>
3325 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3326 on connections accept.
3327
3328bind <addr> [param*]
3329 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003330 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3331 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3332 syslog protocol over TCP.
3333 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003334 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3335
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003336dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003337 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3338 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3339 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3340 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003341 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003342
3343log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003344log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003345 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3346 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3347 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003348 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003349 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3350 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3351 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003352 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003353
3354 Example:
3355 global
3356 log stderr format iso local7
3357
3358 ring myring
3359 description "My local buffer"
3360 format rfc5424
3361 maxlen 1200
3362 size 32764
3363 timeout connect 5s
3364 timeout server 10s
3365 # syslog tcp server
3366 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3367
3368 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003369 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3370 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003371 # all messages on stderr
3372 log global
3373 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3374 log ring@myring local0
3375 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3376 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3377 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3378 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3379 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003380
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003381maxconn <conns>
3382 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3383 10 is the default.
3384
3385timeout client <timeout>
3386 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033884. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003389----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003391Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003392 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3393 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3394 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3395 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003396
3397A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3398connections.
3399
3400A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3401to forward incoming connections.
3402
3403A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3404parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3405
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003406A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3407ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3408sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3409the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3410explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3411from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3412"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3413for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3414to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3415optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3416are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3417any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3418names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3419that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3420duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3421names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3422
3423Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3424settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3425of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3426profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3427timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3430'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3431case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3432
3433Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3434logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3435proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3436However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3437name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3438
3439Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3440and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003441bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3443modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3444arbitrary criteria.
3445
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003446In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3447a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003448the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003449
3450 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3451 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3452 between responses and new requests.
3453
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003454 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3455 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3456 client-facing connection remains open.
3457
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003458 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3459 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003460
3461The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3462frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3463following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003464weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003465
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003466 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003467
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003468 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3469 ----+-----+-----+----
3470 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3471 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003472 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3473 ----+-----+-----+----
3474 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003475
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003476It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003477only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3478within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003479as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003480content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003481and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3482possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003483
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003484There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003485first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003486processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003487second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003488protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3489is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3490new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003491to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003492process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3493already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3494HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3495evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3496one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3497
3498There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3499performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3500tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3501preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3502analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3503HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3504header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3505mitigate this drawback.
3506
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003507There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003508method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3509set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3510in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3511is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3512to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3513above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3514to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3515"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3516frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3517frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3518as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3519upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3520on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3521the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3522upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3523frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3524remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035264.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3527--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003529The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3530limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3531they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3532limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003533marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003534option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003535and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3536with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3537specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003539
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003540 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3541------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3542acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003543backlog X X X -
3544balance X - X X
3545bind - X X -
3546bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547capture cookie - X X -
3548capture request header - X X -
3549capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003550clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3551clitcpka-idle X X X -
3552clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003553compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003554cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003555declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003556default-server X - X X
3557default_backend X X X -
3558description - X X X
3559disabled X X X X
3560dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003561email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003562email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003563email-alert mailers X X X X
3564email-alert myhostname X X X X
3565email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003566enabled X X X X
3567errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003568errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003569errorloc X X X X
3570errorloc302 X X X X
3571-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3572errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003573force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003574filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003575fullconn X - X X
3576grace X X X X
3577hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003578http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003579http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003580http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003581http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003582http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003583http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003584http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003585http-check set-var X - X X
3586http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003587http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003588http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003589http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003590http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003591http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003592id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003593ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003594load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003595log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003596log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003597log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003598log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003599max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600maxconn X X X -
3601mode X X X X
3602monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003603monitor-uri X X X -
3604option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3605option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3606option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3607option allbackups (*) X - X X
3608option checkcache (*) X - X X
3609option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3610option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003611option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003612option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3613option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3615option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003616option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3617option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003618option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003619option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003620option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003621option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003622option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3624option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3625option httpchk X - X X
3626option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003627option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003629option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003630option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003631option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003632option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3633option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3634option logasap (*) X X X -
3635option mysql-check X - X X
3636option nolinger (*) X X X X
3637option originalto X X X X
3638option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003639option pgsql-check X - X X
3640option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003642option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643option smtpchk X - X X
3644option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3645option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3646option splice-request (*) X X X X
3647option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003648option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003649option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3650option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3651-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003652option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003653option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3654option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3655option tcpka X X X X
3656option tcplog X X X X
3657option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003658external-check command X - X X
3659external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3661rate-limit sessions X X X -
3662redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003663-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003664retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003665retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003666server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003667server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003668server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003670srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3671srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3672srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003673stats admin - X X X
3674stats auth X X X X
3675stats enable X X X X
3676stats hide-version X X X X
3677stats http-request - X X X
3678stats realm X X X X
3679stats refresh X X X X
3680stats scope X X X X
3681stats show-desc X X X X
3682stats show-legends X X X X
3683stats show-node X X X X
3684stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003685-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3686stick match - - X X
3687stick on - - X X
3688stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003689stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003690stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003691tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003692tcp-check connect X - X X
3693tcp-check expect X - X X
3694tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003695tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003696tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003697tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003698tcp-check set-var X - X X
3699tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003700tcp-request connection - X X -
3701tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003702tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003703tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003704tcp-response content - - X X
3705tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706timeout check X - X X
3707timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003708timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003709timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003710timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3711timeout http-request X X X X
3712timeout queue X - X X
3713timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003714timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003715timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003716timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003717transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003718unique-id-format X X X -
3719unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003720use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003721use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003722use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3724 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037274.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3728---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003729
3730This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3731
3732
3733acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3734 Declare or complete an access list.
3735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3736 no | yes | yes | yes
3737 Example:
3738 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3739 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3740 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003742 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003743
3744
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003745backlog <conns>
3746 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3748 yes | yes | yes | no
3749 Arguments :
3750 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3751 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003752 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003753
3754 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3755 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3756 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3757 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3758 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3759 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3760 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3761 backlog parameter.
3762
3763 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3764 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3765 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3766
3767 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3768
3769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003770balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003771balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003772 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 yes | no | yes | yes
3775 Arguments :
3776 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3777 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3778 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3779 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3780
3781 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3782 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3783 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3784 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003785 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003786 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003787 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3788 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3789 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3790 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3791 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3792 it, so that you don't worry.
3793
3794 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3795 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3796 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3797 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3798 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3799 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3800 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3801 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003803 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3804 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3805 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3806 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3807 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3808 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3809 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003810 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3811 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3812 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003813
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003814 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003815 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003816 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3817 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003818 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003819 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3820 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3821 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3822 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3823 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003824 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3825 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3826 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3827 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3828 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3829 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003831 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3832 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3833 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3834 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3835 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3836 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3837 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3838 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003839 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003840 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003841 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3842 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3843 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003844
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003845 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3846 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3847 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3848 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3849 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3850 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3851 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3852 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3853 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3854 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3855 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3856 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003857
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003858 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003859 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3860 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3861 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3862 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3863 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3864 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3865 URIs start with a leading "/".
3866
3867 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3868 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3869 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3870 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3871
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003872 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3873 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3874 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3875 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003878 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3879
3880 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003881 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3882 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003883 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3884 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3885 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3886 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003887 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003888 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3889 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003890
3891 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3892 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3893 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3894 server will receive the request.
3895
3896 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3897 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3898 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3899 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3900 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003901 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3902 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3903 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003904
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003905 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3906 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3907 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3908 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3909 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003911 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003912 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3913 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3914 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3915
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003916 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3917 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3918 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3919
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003920 random
3921 random(<draws>)
3922 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003923 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3924 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3925 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3926 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003927 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3928 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3929 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3930 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3931 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3932 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3933 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3934 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3935 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3936 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3937 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3938 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3939 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3940 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3941 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3942 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3943 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3944 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3945 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3946 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003947
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003948 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003949 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003950 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3951 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3952 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3953 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3954 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3955 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003956 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003957 used instead.
3958
3959 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3960 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3961 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3962 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3963
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003964 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3965 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3966 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3967
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003968 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003970 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003971 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3972 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003973
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003974 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3975 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3976 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003977
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003978 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003979 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003980 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3981 NTLM relies on.
3982
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003983 Examples :
3984 balance roundrobin
3985 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003986 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003987 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3988 balance hdr(host)
3989 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003990
3991 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3992 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003994 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003995 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3996 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3997 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003998 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003999
4000 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4001 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4002 defaults to 16 kB.
4003
4004 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4005 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4006
4007 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4008 Round Robin.
4009
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004010 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004011 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4012 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4013 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4014
4015 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4016
4017 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004018 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004019 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4020 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4021 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004022
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004023 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004024
4025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004026bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4027bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004028 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4030 no | yes | yes | no
4031 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004032 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4033 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4034 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4035 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004036 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004037 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4038 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4039 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4040 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4041 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4042 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004043 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004044 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4045 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004046 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004047 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4048 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004049 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004050 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4051 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004052 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004053 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4054 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4055 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4056 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4057 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4058 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4059 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004060 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4061 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4062 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004063 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4064 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4065 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4066 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004067 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4068 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4069 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004070
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004071 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4072 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004073 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4074 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4075 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004076 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4077 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4078 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4079 the range.
4080
4081 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4082 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4083 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4084 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4085 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4086 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4087 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004088 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004089 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004091 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004092 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004093 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4094 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4095 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4096 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4097 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4098 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004100 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4101 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4102 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4103 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004105 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4106 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4107 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4108 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4109 in a frontend.
4110
4111 Example :
4112 listen http_proxy
4113 bind :80,:443
4114 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004115 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004117 listen http_https_proxy
4118 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004119 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004120
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004121 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4122 bind ipv6@:80
4123 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4124 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004126 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004127 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004128
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004129 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4130 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4131 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4132 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4133 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4134
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004135 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004136 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004137
4138
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004139bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004140 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 yes | yes | yes | yes
4143 Arguments :
4144 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4145 may be used to override a default value.
4146
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004147 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004148 option may be combined with other numbers.
4149
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004150 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004151 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4152 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4153 missing from all processes.
4154
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004155 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004156 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004157 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4158 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4159 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4160 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4161 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004162 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004163
4164 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4165 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4166 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4167 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4168 and 'even' instances.
4169
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004170 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4171 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4172 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4173 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004174
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004175 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4176 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4177
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004178 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4179 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4180 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4181
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004182 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4183 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4184
4185 Example :
4186 listen app_ip1
4187 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004188 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004189
4190 listen app_ip2
4191 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004192 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004193
4194 listen management
4195 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004196 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004197
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004198 listen management
4199 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4200 bind-process 1-4
4201
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004202 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004203
4204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004205capture cookie <name> len <length>
4206 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 no | yes | yes | no
4209 Arguments :
4210 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4211 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4212 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4213 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004214 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004215
4216 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4217 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4218 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4219 right if it exceeds <length>.
4220
4221 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4222 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4223 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4224 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4225
4226 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4227 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4228 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4229
4230 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4231 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4232 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004233 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4234 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4235 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236
4237 Example:
4238 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4239
4240 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004241 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242
4243
4244capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004245 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 no | yes | yes | no
4248 Arguments :
4249 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004250 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4252 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4253 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4254
4255 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4256 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4257 it exceeds <length>.
4258
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004259 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004260 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4261 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004262 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4263 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4264 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4265 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004266 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004267 environments to find where the request came from.
4268
4269 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4270 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4271 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4272 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004273
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004274 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4275 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4276 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4277 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4278 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004279
4280 Example:
4281 capture request header Host len 15
4282 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004283 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004285 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004286 about logging.
4287
4288
4289capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004290 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4292 no | yes | yes | no
4293 Arguments :
4294 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004295 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4297 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4298 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4299
4300 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4301 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4302 it exceeds <length>.
4303
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004304 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004305 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4306 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4307 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004308 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4309 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4310 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4311 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004312
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004313 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4314 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4315 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4316 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4317 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004318
4319 Example:
4320 capture response header Content-length len 9
4321 capture response header Location len 15
4322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004323 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004324 about logging.
4325
4326
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004327clitcpka-cnt <count>
4328 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4329 the connection on the client side.
4330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4331 yes | yes | yes | no
4332 Arguments :
4333 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4334
4335 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4336 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004337 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4338 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004339
4340 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4341
4342
4343clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4344 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4345 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4346 client side.
4347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4348 yes | yes | yes | no
4349 Arguments :
4350 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4351 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4352 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4353 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4354
4355 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4356 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004357 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4358 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004359
4360 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4361
4362
4363clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4364 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4366 yes | yes | yes | no
4367 Arguments :
4368 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4369 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4370 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4371 document.
4372
4373 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4374 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004375 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4376 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004377
4378 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4379
4380
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004381compression algo <algorithm> ...
4382compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004383compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004384 Enable HTTP compression.
4385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4386 yes | yes | yes | yes
4387 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004388 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4389 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004390 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004391
4392 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004393 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4394 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4395 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004396
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004397 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004398 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004399
4400 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4401 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4402 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4403 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4404 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004405 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004406
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004407 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4408 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4409 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4410 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4411 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4412 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4413 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004414 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004415
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004416 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004417 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004418 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004419 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004420 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004421 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004422 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004423
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004424 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004425 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4426 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004427 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4428 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004429 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004430 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004431 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4432 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004433 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004434 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4435 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004436
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004437 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004438 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4439 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004440 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004441 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004442 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4443 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4444 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4445 "multipart"
4446 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4447 header
4448 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4449 and later
4450 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4451 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004452 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004453
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004454 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004455
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004456 Examples :
4457 compression algo gzip
4458 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004459
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004460
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004461cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004462 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4463 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004464 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004465 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 yes | no | yes | yes
4468 Arguments :
4469 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4470 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4471 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4472 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4473 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4474 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004475 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004476 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4477 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4478
4479 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004480 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004481 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4482 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4483 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4484 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004485 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4486 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004487 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004488 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4489 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490
4491 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004492 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004493
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004494 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004495 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004496 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004497 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004498 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4499 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4500 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4501 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4502 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4503 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4504 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505
4506 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4507 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4508 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4509 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4510 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4511 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4512 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4513 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4514 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004515 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004516 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4517 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4518 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004519
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004520 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4521 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4522 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004523 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4524 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4525 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4526 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004527 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4528 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4529 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004530
4531 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4532 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4533 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4534 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4535 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4536 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4537 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4538 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4539 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4540
4541 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4542 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4543 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4544 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4545 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4546 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4547 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4548 persistence cookie in the cache.
4549 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4550
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004551 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4552 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004553 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004554 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4555 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004556 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004557 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4558 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4559 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4560 they logout.
4561
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004562 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004563 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4564 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4565 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4566
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004567 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004568 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4569 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4570 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4571 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4572 this attribute.
4573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004574 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004575 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004576 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4577 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4578 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4579 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4580 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4581 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004583 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4584 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4585 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4586 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4587 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4588 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4589 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4590 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004591 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004592 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4593 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4594 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4595 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4596 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4597 the site.
4598
4599 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4600 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4601 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4602 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4603 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4604 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4605 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4606 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4607 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4608 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4609 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4610 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4611 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004612 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004613 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4614 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4615
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004616 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4617 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4618 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4619 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4620 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4621 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4622
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004623 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004624 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4625 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4626 repeated.
4627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4629 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4630 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4631 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004633 Examples :
4634 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4635 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4636 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004637 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004638
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004639 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004640
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004641
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004642declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4643 Declares a capture slot.
4644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4645 no | yes | yes | no
4646 Arguments:
4647 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4648
4649 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4650 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4651 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4652 for use in the response.
4653
4654 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004655 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004656 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4657
4658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004659default-server [param*]
4660 Change default options for a server in a backend
4661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4662 yes | no | yes | yes
4663 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004664 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4665 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4666 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4667 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004668
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004669 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004670 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4671
4672 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004673
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004675default_backend <backend>
4676 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4678 yes | yes | yes | no
4679 Arguments :
4680 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4681
4682 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4683 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4684 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4685 will catch all undetermined requests.
4686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004687 Example :
4688
4689 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4690 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4691 default_backend dynamic
4692
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004693 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004695
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004696description <string>
4697 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4699 no | yes | yes | yes
4700 Arguments : string
4701
4702 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4703 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4704 it describes.
4705 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4706
4707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004708disabled
4709 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4711 yes | yes | yes | yes
4712 Arguments : none
4713
4714 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4715 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4716 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4717 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4718 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4719 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4720 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4721
4722 See also : "enabled"
4723
4724
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004725dispatch <address>:<port>
4726 Set a default server address
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004729 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004730
4731 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4732 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4733 during start-up.
4734
4735 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4736 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4737 possible with normal servers.
4738
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004739 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004740 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4741 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4742 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4743 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4744
4745 See also : "server"
4746
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004747
4748dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4749 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | no | yes | yes
4752 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4753
4754 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004755 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004756 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4757 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004758 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004759 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004761enabled
4762 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 yes | yes | yes | yes
4765 Arguments : none
4766
4767 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4768 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4769
4770 See also : "disabled"
4771
4772
4773errorfile <code> <file>
4774 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 yes | yes | yes | yes
4777 Arguments :
4778 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004779 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004780 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004781
4782 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004783 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004784 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004785 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4786 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004787
4788 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4789 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4790 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4791
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004792 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4793
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004794 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4795 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4796 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4797 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4798 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4799 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4800 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4801 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4802 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004804 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4805 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4806 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004807 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004808 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4809
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004810 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004811
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004812 Example :
4813 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004814 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004815 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4816 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4817
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004818
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004819errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4820 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4821 section.
4822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4823 yes | yes | yes | yes
4824 Arguments :
4825 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4826
4827 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004828 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004829 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4830 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004831
4832 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4833 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4834 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4835 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4836 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004837 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004838 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4839
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004840 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4841 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004842
4843 Example :
4844 errorfiles generic
4845 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4846
4847
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004848errorloc <code> <url>
4849errorloc302 <code> <url>
4850 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4852 yes | yes | yes | yes
4853 Arguments :
4854 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004855 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004856 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004857
4858 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4859 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4860 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4861 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004862 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004863
4864 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4865 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4866 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4867
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004868 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4869
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004870 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4871 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4872 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4873 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004874 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004875 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4876 request.
4877
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004878 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879
4880
4881errorloc303 <code> <url>
4882 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4884 yes | yes | yes | yes
4885 Arguments :
4886 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004887 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004888 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004889
4890 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4891 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4892 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4893 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004894 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004895
4896 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4897 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4898 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4899
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004900 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4901
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004902 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4903 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4904 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4905 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004906 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004907
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004908 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004909
4910
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004911email-alert from <emailaddr>
4912 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004913 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916
4917 Arguments :
4918
4919 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4920
4921 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4922 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4923
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004924 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004925 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4926 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004927
4928
4929email-alert level <level>
4930 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4931 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4932 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 yes | yes | yes | yes
4934
4935 Arguments :
4936
4937 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4938 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4939 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4940
4941 By default level is alert
4942
4943 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4944 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4945 for the proxy.
4946
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004947 Alerts are sent when :
4948
4949 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4950 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4951 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4952 is notice or lower
4953 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4954 and a health check status update occurs
4955
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004956 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4957 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004958 section 3.6 about mailers.
4959
4960
4961email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4962 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4964 yes | yes | yes | yes
4965
4966 Arguments :
4967
4968 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4969
4970 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4971 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4972
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004973 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4974 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004975
4976
4977email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4978 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4979 mailers.
4980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4981 yes | yes | yes | yes
4982
4983 Arguments :
4984
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004985 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004986
4987 By default the systems hostname is used.
4988
4989 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4990 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4991 for the proxy.
4992
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004993 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4994 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004995
4996
4997email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004998 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004999 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | yes | yes | yes
5002
5003 Arguments :
5004
5005 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5006
5007 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5008 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5009
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005010 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005011 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5012
5013
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005014force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5015 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005017 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005018
5019 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5020 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5021 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5022 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5023 marked down for maintenance operations.
5024
5025 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5026 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5027 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5028 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5029 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5030 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5031 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5032 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5033 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5034
5035 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5036 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5037 is used.
5038
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005039 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005040 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005041
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005042
5043filter <name> [param*]
5044 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5046 no | yes | yes | yes
5047 Arguments :
5048 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5049 referenced in section 9.
5050
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005051 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005052 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005053 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5054 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005055
5056 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5057 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5058
5059 Example:
5060 listen
5061 bind *:80
5062
5063 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5064 filter compression
5065 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5066
5067 compression algo gzip
5068 compression offload
5069
5070 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5071
5072 See also : section 9.
5073
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005074
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005075fullconn <conns>
5076 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5078 yes | no | yes | yes
5079 Arguments :
5080 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5081 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5082
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005083 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005084 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005085 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005086 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5087 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5088 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5089 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5090 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005091 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005092
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005093 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005094 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005095 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5096 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5097 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005098
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005099 Example :
5100 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5101 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5102 # connections.
5103 backend dynamic
5104 fullconn 10000
5105 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5106 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5107
5108 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5109
5110
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005111grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005112 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005114 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005115 Arguments :
5116 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5117 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5118 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5119
5120 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5121 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005122 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005123 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5124
5125 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5126 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5127 simplify it.
5128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005129
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005130hash-balance-factor <factor>
5131 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 yes | no | no | yes
5134 Arguments :
5135 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5136 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005137 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005138
5139 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5140 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5141 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5142 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5143 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5144 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5145 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5146
5147 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5148 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5149 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5150 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5151 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5152
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005153 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5154 consistent hashing mechanism.
5155
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005156 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5157
5158
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005159hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005160 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5162 yes | no | yes | yes
5163 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005164 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5165 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005166
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005167 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5168 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5169 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5170 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5171 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5172 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5173 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5174 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5175 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5176 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005177
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005178 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5179 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5180 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5181 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5182 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5183 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5184 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5185 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5186 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5187 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5188 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5189 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5190 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005191 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5192 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005193
5194 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5195
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005196 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005197 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5198 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5199 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005200 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5201 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5202 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005203
5204 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5205 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005206 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5207 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5208 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5209 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5210
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005211 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005212 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5213 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5214 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5215 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5216 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5217 parameter.
5218
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005219 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5220 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5221 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5222 used on strings.
5223
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005224 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5225
5226 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5227 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5228 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5229 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5230 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5231 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5232 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5233 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5234 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5235 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5236 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5237 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005238
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005239 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5240 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5241 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005242
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005243 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005244
5245
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005246http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5247 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5248 ones).
5249
5250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5251 no | yes | yes | yes
5252
5253 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5254 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5255 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5256 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5257 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5258 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5259
5260 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5261 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5262 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5263
5264 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5265 below.
5266
5267 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5268 instance.
5269
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005270 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5271 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5272 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5273
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005274 Example:
5275 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5276 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5277 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5278
5279http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5280
5281 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5282 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5283 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5284 example, or to pass some internal information.
5285 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5286 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5287 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5288
5289http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5290
5291 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5292 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5293
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005294http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005295
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005296 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5297 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5298 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5299 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5300 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005301
5302http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5303 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5304
5305 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5306
5307 Example:
5308 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5309
5310 # applied to:
5311 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5312
5313 # outputs:
5314 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5315
5316 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5317
5318http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5319 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5320
5321 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5322
5323 Example:
5324 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5325
5326 # applied to:
5327 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5328
5329 # outputs:
5330 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5331
5332http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5333
5334 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5335 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5336 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5337
5338http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5340
5341 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5342 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5343 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5344 fallback.
5345
5346 Example:
5347 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5348 http-response set-status 431
5349 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5350 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5351
5352http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5353
5354 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5355 inline.
5356
5357 Arguments:
5358 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5359 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5360 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5361 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5362 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5363 (request and response)
5364 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5365 processing
5366 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5367 processing
5368 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5369 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5370 and '_'.
5371
5372 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5373 followed by some converters.
5374
5375 Example:
5376 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5377
5378http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5379
5380 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5381 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5382 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5383 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5384 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005385 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005386 processing.
5387
5388 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5389 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005390 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005391 rules evaluation.
5392
5393http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5394
5395 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5396 details about <var-name>.
5397
5398 Example:
5399 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5400
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005401
5402http-check comment <string>
5403 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5404 it fails.
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | no | yes | yes
5407
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005408 Arguments :
5409 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5410 rule fails.
5411
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005412 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5413 user-friendly error reporting.
5414
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005415 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005416 "http-check expect".
5417
5418
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005419http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5420 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005421 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005422 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5424 yes | no | yes | yes
5425
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005426 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005427 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5428
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005429 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005430 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005431
5432 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5433 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5434 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5435 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5436
5437 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5438
5439 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5440
5441 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5442
5443 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5444
5445 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5446
5447 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5448 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5449 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5450 is used.
5451
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005452 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5453 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5454 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5455 haproxy -vv.
5456
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005457 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5458
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005459 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5460 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5461 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5462 different ports or with different servers.
5463
5464 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5465 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5466 the port with a "http-check connect".
5467
5468 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5469 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5470 do.
5471
5472 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5473 unset-var or comment rules.
5474
5475 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005476 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5477 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5478 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5479 option httpchk
5480
5481 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005482 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005483 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005484 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005485 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005486 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005487
5488 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5489
5490 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005491
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005493http-check disable-on-404
5494 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005496 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005497 Arguments : none
5498
5499 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5500 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5501 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5502 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5503 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5504 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5505 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5506 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005507 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5508 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005509 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5510 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5511 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005512
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005513 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514
5515
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005516http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005517 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5518 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5519 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005520 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005522 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005523
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005524 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005525 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5526
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005527 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5528 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5529 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5530 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5531 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5532 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5533 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5534 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5535 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5536 result is always conclusive.
5537
5538 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5539 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5540 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005541 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5542 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005543 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5544 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005545 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5546 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5547 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005548
5549 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5550 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005551 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5552 supported :
5553 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5554 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005555 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5556 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5557 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5558 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5559 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005560
5561 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5562 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005563 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5564 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5565 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5566 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005567 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5568
5569 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5570 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5571 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5572 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5573
5574 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5575 informational message reported in logs if an error
5576 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5577 log-format string.
5578
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005579 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005580 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5581 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005582 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5583 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5584 details on the supported keywords.
5585
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005586 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5587 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5588 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5589 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005590
5591 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5592 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5593 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5594 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5595 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5596
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005597 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5598 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5599 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5600 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5601 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5602 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5603 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005604
5605 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005606 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005607 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5608 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5609 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5610 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5611
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005612 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5613 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005614 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5615 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5616 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5617 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5618 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5619 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5620 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5621 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005622 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5623 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5624 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5625 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5626 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5627 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5628 insensitive on the header names.
5629
5630 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5631 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5632 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5633 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5634 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5635 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005636
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005637 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005638 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005639 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5640 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5641 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5642 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5643 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005644 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645 trace).
5646
5647 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005648 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005649 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5650 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5651 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5652 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5653 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005654 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005655
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005656 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5657 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5658 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5659 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5660 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5661 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5662
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005663 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005664 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005665 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5666 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5667 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5668 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5669 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5670 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5671
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005672 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5673 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5674 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5675 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5676 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005677
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005678 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5679 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5680
5681 Examples :
5682 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005683 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005684
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005685 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5686 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5687
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005688 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005689 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005690
5691 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005692 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005693
5694 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005695 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005696
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005697 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005698 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699
5700
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005701http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005702 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5703 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005704 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5705 health checks.
5706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5707 yes | no | yes | yes
5708 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005709 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5710
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005711 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5712 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5713 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5714 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5715 to invent non-standard ones.
5716
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005717 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5718 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5719 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5720 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5721
5722 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5723 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5724 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5725 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005726
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005727 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005728 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005729 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005730 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5731 to add it.
5732
5733 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5734 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5735 to the log-format rules.
5736
5737 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5738 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5739 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005740
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005741 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5742 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5743 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5744 request.
5745
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005746 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5747 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5748 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005749 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5750 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5751 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5752 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005753 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005754
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005755 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005756 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5757 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005758
5759 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5760 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5761 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5762 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5763 configured request authority.
5764
5765 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5766 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005767
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005768 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005769
5770
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005771http-check send-state
5772 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | no | yes | yes
5775 Arguments : none
5776
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005777 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005778 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005779 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5780 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5781 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005782
5783 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5784 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5785 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5786 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5787 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005788 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5789 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5790 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5791
5792 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5793 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5794 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5795
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005796 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5797 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5798 checked in multiple backends.
5799
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005800 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005801 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5802
5803 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5804 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5805 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5806 one fails.
5807
5808 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5809 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5810 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5811
5812 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5813 server's queue.
5814
5815 Example of a header received by the application server :
5816 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5817 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5818
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005819 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5820 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005821
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005822
5823http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005824 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5826 yes | no | yes | yes
5827
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005828 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005829 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5830 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5831 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5832 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5833 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5834 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5835 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5836 and '-'.
5837
5838 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5839
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005840 Examples :
5841 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005842
5843
5844http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005845 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5847 yes | no | yes | yes
5848
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005849 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005850 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5851 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5852 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5853 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5854 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5855 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5856 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5857 and '-'.
5858
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005859 Examples :
5860 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005862
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005863http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5864 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5865 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5866 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5867 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5869 yes | yes | yes | yes
5870 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005871 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005872 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005873 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005874 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005875
5876 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5877 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5878 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5879 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5880
5881 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5882 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5883 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5884 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5885
5886 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5887 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5888 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5889 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5890 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5891 chroot is performed.
5892
5893 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5894 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5895 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5896 considered.
5897
5898 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5899 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5900 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5901 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5902 considered as a raw string.
5903
5904 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5905 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5906 "content-type".
5907
5908 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5909 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5910 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5911 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5912 evaluated as a log-format string.
5913
5914 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5915 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5916 argument to "content-type".
5917
5918 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5919 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5920 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5921 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5922
5923 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5924 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5925 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5926 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5927 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5928 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5929 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5930 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5931
5932 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5933 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5934 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5935
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005936 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5937 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5938 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5939 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5940 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5941
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005942 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5943 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5944
5945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005946http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005947 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5948
5949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 no | yes | yes | yes
5951
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005952 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5953 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5954 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5955 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5956 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005958 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5959 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005960
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005961 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005962
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005963 Example:
5964 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5965 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5966 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005967
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005968 http-request allow if nagios
5969 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5970 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5971 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005972
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005973 Example:
5974 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5975 acl add path /addacl
5976 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005978 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5981 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005983 Example:
5984 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5985 acl setmap path /setmap
5986 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005988 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005989
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005990 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5991 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5994 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005996http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005998 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5999 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6000 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6001 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6002 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6003 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6004 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6005 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006006
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006007http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6010 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6011 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6012 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6013 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6014 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6015 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6016 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6021 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006022
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6027 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6028 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6029 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6030 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006031
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006032 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6033 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6034 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6035 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6036 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6037 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6038 instead.
6039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040 Example:
6041 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6042 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006043
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006044http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006045
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006046 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6052 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6053 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6054 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6055 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6056 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6057 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6058 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6059 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6062 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6063 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006064 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6065
6066 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6067 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6068 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6069 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006073 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6074 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6075 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6076 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6077 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6078 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006079
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006080http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006081
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006082 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6083 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6084 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6085 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6086 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6091 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6092 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6093 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6094 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6095 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006096
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006097http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6098http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6099 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6100 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6101 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6102 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006103
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006104 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6105 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6106 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006107 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006108 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6109 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6110 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006111 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006112 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006113
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006114http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6115 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6116 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6117 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6118
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006119http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6120
6121 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6122 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6123 pointed by <resolvers>.
6124 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6125 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6126 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6127 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6128 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6129 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6130 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6131 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6132 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6133 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6134 to 0.0.0.0.
6135
6136 Example:
6137 resolvers mydns
6138 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6139 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6140 timeout retry 1s
6141 hold valid 10s
6142 hold nx 3s
6143 hold other 3s
6144 hold obsolete 0s
6145 accepted_payload_size 8192
6146
6147 frontend fe
6148 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6149 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6150 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6151
6152 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6153 # which mean DNS resolution error
6154 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6155
6156 default_backend be
6157
6158 backend b_503
6159 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6160 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6161 # 503 error page to end users
6162
6163 backend be
6164 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6165 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6166 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6167 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6168 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6169
6170 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6171 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6172
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006173http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6174
6175 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6176 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6177 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6178 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006179 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6180 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006181
6182 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6183
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006184http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006185http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006186http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006187http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006188http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006189http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006190http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006191http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6192http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006193
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006194 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6195
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006196 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006197 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6198 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6199 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6200 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006201
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006202 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6203 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6204 the supported backend.
6205
6206 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6207 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6208 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6209 number of segments in the path.
6210
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006211 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6212 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6213 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6214 when improperly combined.
6215
6216 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6217 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6218 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6219 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6220 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6221
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006222 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006223
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006224 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6225
6226 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6227 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6228
6229 Example:
6230 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6231
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006232 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6233
6234 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6235 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6236
6237 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6238 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6239
6240 Example:
6241 - /#foo -> /
6242
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006243 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6244 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006245
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006246 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6247 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6248
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006249 Example:
6250 - /. -> /
6251 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6252 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6253 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006254
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006255 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6256 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6257
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006258 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006259 their preceding segment.
6260
6261 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6262 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6263
6264 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6265 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006266
6267 Example:
6268 - /foo/../ -> /
6269 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6270 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6271 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006272 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006273 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006274 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006275
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006276 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6277 removed as well:
6278
6279 Example:
6280 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6281 - /bar/../../ -> /
6282
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006283 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6284 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006285
6286 Example:
6287 - // -> /
6288 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6289
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006290 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6291 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6292
6293 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6294 ".", "_", and "~".
6295
6296 Example:
6297 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6298 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6299 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6300 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6301
6302 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6303 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6304
6305 Example:
6306 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6307 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6308
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006309 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006310 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006311
6312 Example:
6313 - /%6f -> /%6F
6314 - /%zz -> /%zz
6315
6316 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6317 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6318
6319 Example:
6320 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6321
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006322 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006323 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6324 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6325
6326 Example:
6327 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6328 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6329 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006331http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006333 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6334 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6335 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6336 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6337 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006339http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006341 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6342 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6343 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6344 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006346http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006348
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006349 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006350 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6351 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6352 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6353 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6354 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006355
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006356 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6357 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6358 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6359 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6360 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006361
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006362 Example:
6363 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6364
6365 # applied to:
6366 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6367
6368 # outputs:
6369 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6370
6371 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006372
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006373 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6374
6375 # applied to:
6376 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006377
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006378 # outputs:
6379 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006380
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006381http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6382 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6383
6384 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6385 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006386 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6387 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6388 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006389
6390 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6391 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6392 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6393
6394 Example:
6395 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6396 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6397
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006398 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6399 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6400 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6401 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6402
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006403http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6404 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6405
6406 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6407 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6408 query-string are replaced.
6409
6410 Example:
6411 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6412 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6413
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006414http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6415 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6416
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006417 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6418 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6419 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6420 against.
6421
6422 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6423 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6424 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006425
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006426 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6427 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6428 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6429 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6430 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6431 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6432 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6433 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6434 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006435 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6436 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006437
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006438 Example:
6439 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6440 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006441
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006442 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6443 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006445http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006447
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006448 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6449 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6450 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6451 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006452
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006453 Example:
6454 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006455
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006456 # applied to:
6457 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006458
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006459 # outputs:
6460 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006461
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006462http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6463 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6464 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006465 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006466 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6467
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006468 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006469 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6470 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006471 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006472 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006473 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006474 are followed to create the response :
6475
6476 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6477 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6478 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6479 ignored.
6480
6481 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6482 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006483 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006484 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6485 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006486
6487 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6488 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6489 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006490 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006491 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006492
6493 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6494 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6495 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006496 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006497 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006498 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499
6500 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6501 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6502 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6503 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6504 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6505 as a raw content.
6506
6507 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6508 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6509 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6510 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6511 considered as a raw string.
6512
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006513 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006514 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6515 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6516 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6517
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006518 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6519 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006520 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006521
6522 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6523
6524 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006525 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006526 if { path /ping }
6527
6528 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6529 if { path /favicon.ico }
6530
6531 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6532 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6533 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006535http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6536http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006538 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6539 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6540 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006541
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006542http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6543 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006544
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006545 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6546 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6547 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6548 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006550http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006552 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6553 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6554 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6555 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6556 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006558 Arguments:
6559 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6560 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006562 Example:
6563 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6564 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006566 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6567 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006570
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006571 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6572 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6573 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575 Arguments:
6576 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6577 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006579 Example:
6580 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6581 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6584 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6585 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6590 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6591 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6592 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6593 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006595 Example:
6596 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6597 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6598 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6599 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6600 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6601 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6602 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6603 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6604 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6609 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6610 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6611 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6612 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6615 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6618 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6619 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6620 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6621 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6622 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6623 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6624 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6625 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006627http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006629 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6630 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6631 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6632 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6633 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6634 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6635 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006637http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6640 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6641 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6646 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6647 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6648 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6649 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6650 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6651 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6652 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6657 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6658 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6659 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6660 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6661 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663 Example :
6664 # prepend the host name before the path
6665 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006666
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006667http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6668
6669 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6670 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6671 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006673http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006675 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6676 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6677 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6678 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6679 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006682
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006683 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6684 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6685 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6686 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6687 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6688 values have higher priority.
6689 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6690 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6691 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6692 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6693 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006697 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6698 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6699 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6700 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6701 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6702 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6703 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006706
6707 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6709 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006711http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6712 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6713 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6714 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006715 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6716 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006717
6718 Arguments :
6719 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6720 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006721
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006722 See also "option forwardfor".
6723
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006724 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6726 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6727
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006728 # After the masking this will track connections
6729 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6730 http-request track-sc0 src
6731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006732 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6733 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6734
6735http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6736
6737 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6738 expression.
6739
6740 Arguments:
6741 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6742 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006743
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006744 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6746 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6747
6748 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6749 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6750 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6751
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006752http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006753 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6754
6755 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6756 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6757 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6758 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6759 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6760
6761 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6762 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6763 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6764 results.
6765
6766 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006767 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6768 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006770http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6771
6772 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6773 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6774 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6775 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6776 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6777 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6778 information from the request.
6779
6780 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6781
6782http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6783
6784 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6785 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6786 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6787 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6788 path and the query string.
6789 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6790
6791http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6792
6793 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6794 inline.
6795
6796 Arguments:
6797 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6798 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6799 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6800 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6801 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6802 (request and response)
6803 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6804 processing
6805 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6806 processing
6807 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6808 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6809 and '_'.
6810
6811 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6812 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006813
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006814 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006815 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006817http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6818 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006820 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6821 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6822 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6823 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6824 agent name must be used.
6825
6826 Arguments:
6827 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6828
6829 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6830 configuration.
6831
6832http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6833
6834 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6835 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6836 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6837 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6838 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6839 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6840 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6841 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6842 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6843 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6844 action.
6845 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6846 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6847 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6848 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6849 you fully understand how it works.
6850
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006851http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6852
6853 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6854 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6855 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6856 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6857 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006858 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006859 processing.
6860
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006861 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006862 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6863 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6864 rules evaluation.
6865
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006866http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6867http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6868 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6869 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6870 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6871 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006872
6873 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6874 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6875 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006876 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6877 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6878 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6879 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6880 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6881 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006882 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006883 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6884 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6885 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006886 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006887 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6888 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6889 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6890 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6891 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006892
6893http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6894http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6895http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6896
6897 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6898 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6899 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6900 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006901 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006902 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6903 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6904 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6905 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6906 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6907 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6908 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6909
6910 Arguments :
6911 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6912 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6913 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6914 select which table entry to update the counters.
6915
6916 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6917 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6918 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6919 that table until the session ends.
6920
6921 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6922 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6923 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6924 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6925 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6926 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6927 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6928 useful information.
6929
6930 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6931 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6932 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6933 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6934 checks that make use of it.
6935
6936http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6937
6938 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006939
6940 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006941 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006942
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006943http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6944
6945 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6946 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6947 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6948 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6949 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6950 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6951
6952 Arguments :
6953 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6954
6955 Example:
6956 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6957
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006958http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6959 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6960
6961 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6962 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6963 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6964 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6965 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6966 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6967 http-buffer-request".
6968
6969 Arguments :
6970
6971 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6972 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6973
6974 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006975 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006976 bytes.
6977
6978 Example:
6979 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6980
6981 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006983http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006984
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006985 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6986 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6987 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006988
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006990http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006991 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6992
6993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 no | yes | yes | yes
6995
6996 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6997 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6998 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6999 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7000 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7001 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007003 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7004 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007006 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007008 Example:
7009 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007011 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007013 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7014 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007016 Example:
7017 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007019 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007021 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7022 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007024 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7025 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007027http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007029 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7030 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7031 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7032 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7033 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7034 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7035 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7036 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007038http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7041 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7042 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7043 example, or to pass some internal information.
7044 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7045 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7046 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007048http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7051 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007052
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007053http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007054
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007055 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7060 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7061 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7062 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7063 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7064 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7065 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7068 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7069 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7070 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7071 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007072
7073 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7074 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7075 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7076 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7081 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7082 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7083 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7084 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7085 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007086
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007087http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007088
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007089 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7090 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7091 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7092 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7093 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007095http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007097 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7098 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7099 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7100 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7101 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7102 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007103
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007104http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7105http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7106 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7107 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7108 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7109 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007110
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007111 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7112 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7113 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007114 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007115 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7116 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7117 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007118 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007119 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007121http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007122
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007123 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7124 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7125 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7126 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7127 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7128 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007130http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7131 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007132
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007133 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7134 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007136 Example:
7137 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007139 # applied to:
7140 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007142 # outputs:
7143 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007145 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007147http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007149
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007150 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007151 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007153 Example:
7154 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007156 # applied to:
7157 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007159 # outputs:
7160 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007161
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007162http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7163 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7164 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007165 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007166 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7167
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007168 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007169 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7170 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007171 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007172 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007173 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007174 are followed to create the response :
7175
7176 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7177 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7178 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7179 ignored.
7180
7181 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7182 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007183 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007184 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7185 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007186
7187 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7188 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7189 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007190 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007191 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007192
7193 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7194 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7195 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007196 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007197 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007198 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007199
7200 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7201 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7202 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7203 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7204 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7205 as a raw content.
7206
7207 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7208 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7209 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7210 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7211 considered as a raw string.
7212
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007213 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7214 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7215 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7216 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7217
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007218 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7219 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007220 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007221
7222 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7223
7224 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007225 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007226 if { status eq 404 }
7227
7228 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7229 string "This is the end !" \
7230 if { status eq 500 }
7231
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007232http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7233http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007234
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007235 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7236 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7237 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007238
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007239http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007241
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007242 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7243 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7244 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7245 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007247http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007249 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7250 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7251 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7252 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7253 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007255 Arguments:
7256 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007257
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007258 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7259 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007260
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007261http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007263 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7264 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7265 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007266
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007267http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7268
7269 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7270 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7271 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7272 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7273 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7274
7275http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7276
7277 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7278 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7279 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7280 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7281 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7282 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7283 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7284 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7285 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7286
7287http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7288
7289 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7290 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7291 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7292 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7293 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7294 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7295 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7296
7297http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7298
7299 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7300 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7301 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7302 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7303 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7304 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7305 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7306 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7307
7308http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7309 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7310
7311 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7312 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7313 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7314 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007315
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007316 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007317 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7318 http-response set-status 431
7319 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7320 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007322http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007324 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7325 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7326 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7327 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7328 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7329 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7330 based on some information from the request.
7331
7332 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7333
7334http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7335
7336 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7337 inline.
7338
7339 Arguments:
7340 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7341 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7342 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7343 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7344 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7345 (request and response)
7346 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7347 processing
7348 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7349 processing
7350 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7351 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7352 and '_'.
7353
7354 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7355 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007356
7357 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007358 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007362 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7363 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7364 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7365 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7366 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7367 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7368 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7369 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7370 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7371 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7372 action.
7373 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7374 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7375 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7376 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7377 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007378
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007379http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7380
7381 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7382 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7383 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7384 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7385 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007386 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007387 processing.
7388
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007389 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007390 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007391 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007392 rules evaluation.
7393
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007394http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7395http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7396http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007397
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007398 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7399 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7400 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7401 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7402 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007403 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007404
7405http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7406
7407 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7408 about <var-name>.
7409
7410 Example:
7411 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7412
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007413http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7414 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7415
7416 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7417 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7418 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7419 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7420 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7421 buffer is full.
7422
7423 Arguments :
7424
7425 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7426 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7427
7428 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007429 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007430 bytes.
7431
7432 Example:
7433 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007434
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007435http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7436 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7437
7438 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7439 yes | no | yes | yes
7440
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007441 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007442 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7443 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7444 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007445
7446 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7447
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007448 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7449 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7450 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7451 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7452 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7453 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7454 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007455 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007456 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7457 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007458
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007459 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7460 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7461 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7462 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7463 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7464 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7465 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007466 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7467 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7468 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7469 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7470 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7471 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007472
7473 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7474 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7475 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7476 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7477 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7478 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7479 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7480 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007481 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007482 downsides of rare connection failures.
7483
7484 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7485 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7486 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7487 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7488 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7489 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007490 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007491 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7492 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7493 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7494 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7495 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7496
7497 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007498 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7499 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7500 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7501 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007502
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007503 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7504 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007505
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007506 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007507
7508 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7509 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7510 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7511
7512 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7513
7514
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007515http-send-name-header [<header>]
7516 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007517 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7518 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007519 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007520 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7521
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007522 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7523 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7524 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7525 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7526 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7527 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7528 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7529 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7530 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7531 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7532 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7533 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7534 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7535 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7536 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7537 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007538
7539 See also : "server"
7540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007541id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007542 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7544 no | yes | yes | yes
7545 Arguments : none
7546
7547 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7548 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7549 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007550
7551
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007552ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7553 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007555 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007556
7557 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7558 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7559 and running).
7560
7561 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7562 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7563 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007564 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007565 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7566
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007567 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7568 "unless" condition is met.
7569
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007570 Example:
7571 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7572 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7573 ignore-persist if url_static
7574
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007575 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7576
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007577load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7578 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7580 yes | no | yes | yes
7581
7582 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7583 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7584 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007585 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007586 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007587 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7588 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7589 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7590
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007591 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007592 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007593 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007594
7595 Arguments:
7596 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7597 named "server-state-file".
7598
7599 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7600 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7601 name is used as a file name.
7602
7603 none don't load any stat for this backend
7604
7605 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007606 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7607 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7608 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007609 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007610 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007611
7612 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7613 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7614
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007615 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007616
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007617 global
7618 stats socket /tmp/socket
7619 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007620
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007621 defaults
7622 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007623
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007624 backend bk
7625 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7626 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007627
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007628
7629 Then one can run :
7630
7631 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7632
7633 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7634
7635 1
7636 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7637 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7638 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7639
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007640 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007641
7642 global
7643 stats socket /tmp/socket
7644 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7645
7646 defaults
7647 load-server-state-from-file local
7648
7649 backend bk
7650 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7651 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7652
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007653
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007654 Then one can run :
7655
7656 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7657
7658 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7659
7660 1
7661 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7662 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7663 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7664
7665 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7666 "show servers state"
7667
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007668
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007669log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007670log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007671 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007672no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007673 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7675 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007676
7677 Prefix :
7678 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7679 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7680 prefix does not allow arguments.
7681
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007682 Arguments :
7683 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7684 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7685 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7686 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7687 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7688 parameter.
7689
7690 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7691 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7692
7693 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7694 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7695 standard syslog port).
7696
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007697 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7698 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7699 standard syslog port).
7700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007701 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7702 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7703 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007704 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007705
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007706 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7707 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7708 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7709 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7710 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7711 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7712 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7713 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7714 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7715 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7716 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7717 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007718 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007719 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7720 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7721 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007722 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7723 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007724
7725 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7726 and "fd@2", see above.
7727
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007728 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7729 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7730 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7731 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7732 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7733 having the logs instantly available.
7734
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007735 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7736 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7737 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7738
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007739 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7740 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007741
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007742 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7743 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7744 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7745 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7746 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7747 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7748 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7749 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7750 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7751 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007752 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007753
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007754 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7755 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7756 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7757 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7758 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7759
7760 <sample_size>
7761 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7762 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7763 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7764 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7765 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7766
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007767 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7768 one of the following :
7769
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007770 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7771 field is stripped. This is the default.
7772 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7773 rfc3164.
7774
7775 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007776 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7777
7778 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7779 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7780
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007781 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7782 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7783 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7784 designed to be used with a local log server.
7785
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007786 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7787 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7788 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7789 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7790 systemd logger consumes.
7791
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007792 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7793 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7794 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7795 used with a local log server.
7796
7797 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7798 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7799 designed to be used with a local log server.
7800
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007801 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7802 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7803 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7804 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7805
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007806 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7807
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007808 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7809 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7810 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7811
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007812 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7813 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7814 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7815 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007816
7817 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7818 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7819 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007820 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7821 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7822 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7823 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7824 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007825
7826 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7827
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007828 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7829 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7830 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007831
7832 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7833 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7834 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7835 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7836
7837 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7838 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007839
7840 Example :
7841 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007842 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7843 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7844 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007845 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007846 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7847 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007848 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007850
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007851log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007852 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7854 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007855
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007856 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7857 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7858 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7859 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7860 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007861
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007862 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7863 "option httplog" directives.
7864
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007865log-format-sd <string>
7866 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7868 yes | yes | yes | no
7869
7870 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7871 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7872 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7873 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7874 which covers the log format string in depth.
7875
7876 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7877 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7878
7879 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7880 log format to "rfc5424".
7881
7882 Example :
7883 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7884
7885
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007886log-tag <string>
7887 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7889 yes | yes | yes | yes
7890
7891 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7892 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007893 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007894 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7895 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7896 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7897 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7898 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7899 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007900
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007901max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7902 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7903 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7904 yes | no | yes | yes
7905
7906 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7907 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7908 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7909 servers.
7910
7911 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007912 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007913 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7914 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7915 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007916 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007917 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7918 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7919 picking a different server.
7920
7921 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7922 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7923 even if they have to be queued.
7924
7925 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7926 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7927
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007928max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7929 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7930 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7931 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007933maxconn <conns>
7934 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7936 yes | yes | yes | no
7937 Arguments :
7938 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7939 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7940 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7941 closes.
7942
7943 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007944 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007945 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7946 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007947 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7948 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7949 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7950 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007951
7952 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7953 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7954 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7955
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007956 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7957 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007959 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7960
7961
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007962mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007963 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7965 yes | yes | yes | yes
7966 Arguments :
7967 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7968 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7969 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7970 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7971
7972 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7973 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7974 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7975 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7976 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7977
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007978 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7979 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7980 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007981
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007982 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007983 defaults http_instances
7984 mode http
7985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007986
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007987monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007988 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7990 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007991 Arguments :
7992 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7993 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007994 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007995 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7996 backend and its backup.
7997
7998 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7999 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8000 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8001 servers in a list of backends.
8002
8003 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8004 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8005 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008006 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008007 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8008 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008009 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008010 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8011 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008012
8013 Example:
8014 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008015 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008016 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8017 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8018 monitor-uri /site_alive
8019 monitor fail if site_dead
8020
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008021 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008022
8023
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008024monitor-uri <uri>
8025 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8027 yes | yes | yes | no
8028 Arguments :
8029 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8030 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8031
8032 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8033 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8034 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8035 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8036 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8037 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8038 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8039 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8040
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008041 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008042 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8043 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8044 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8045 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8046 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8047 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008049 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8050 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8051 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8052 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8053
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008054 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008055 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008056 frontend www
8057 mode http
8058 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8059
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008060 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008062
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008063option abortonclose
8064no option abortonclose
8065 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8067 yes | no | yes | yes
8068 Arguments : none
8069
8070 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8071 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8072 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8073 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008074 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008075 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8076 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8077 encountered while delivering the response.
8078
8079 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8080 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8081 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8082 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8083 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8084 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008085 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008086 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008087 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008088 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8089 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8090 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8091
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008092 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8093 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008094 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8095 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8096 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8097 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8098 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8099 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008100 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008101
8102 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8103 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8104
8105 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8106
8107
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008108option accept-invalid-http-request
8109no option accept-invalid-http-request
8110 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | yes | yes | no
8113 Arguments : none
8114
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008115 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008116 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008117 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008118 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8119 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8120 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8121 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8122 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008123 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8124 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8125 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8126 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008127 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008128 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008129 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8130 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8131 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008132
8133 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8134 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8135 been confirmed.
8136
8137 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8138 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008139 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8140 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008141 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8142
8143 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8144 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8145
8146 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8147 stats socket.
8148
8149
8150option accept-invalid-http-response
8151no option accept-invalid-http-response
8152 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8154 yes | no | yes | yes
8155 Arguments : none
8156
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008157 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008158 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008159 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008160 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8161 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8162 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8163 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8164 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008165 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8166 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8167 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008168
8169 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8170 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8171 been confirmed.
8172
8173 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8174 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8175 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8176 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8177
8178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8180
8181 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8182 stats socket.
8183
8184
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008185option allbackups
8186no option allbackups
8187 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8189 yes | no | yes | yes
8190 Arguments : none
8191
8192 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8193 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8194 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8195 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8196 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8197 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8198 order between the backup servers anymore.
8199
8200 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8201 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8202
8203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8205
8206
8207option checkcache
8208no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008209 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8211 yes | no | yes | yes
8212 Arguments : none
8213
8214 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8215 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008216 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008217 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8218 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008219 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008220
8221 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008222 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008223 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008224 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8225 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008226 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008227 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008228 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8229 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008230 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008231 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8232 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008233 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008234 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8235 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8236 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8237 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8238 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8239 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8240 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8241 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8242 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8243
8244 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008245 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8246 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8247 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8248 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008249
8250 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8251 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008252 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008253 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008254
8255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8257
8258
8259option clitcpka
8260no option clitcpka
8261 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8263 yes | yes | yes | no
8264 Arguments : none
8265
8266 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8267 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008268 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008269 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8270
8271 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8272 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8273 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8274 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8275
8276 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8277 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8278 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8279 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8280 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8281
8282 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8283
8284 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8285 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8286 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8287
8288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8290
8291 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8292
8293
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008294option contstats
8295 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8297 yes | yes | yes | no
8298 Arguments : none
8299
8300 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8301 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8302 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008303 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008304 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8305 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8306 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8307 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8308 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008309
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008310option disable-h2-upgrade
8311no option disable-h2-upgrade
8312 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8313 connection.
8314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8315 yes | yes | yes | no
8316 Arguments : none
8317
8318 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8319 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8320 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8321 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008322 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8323 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8324 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8325 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8326 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8327 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008328
8329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008331
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008332option dontlog-normal
8333no option dontlog-normal
8334 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8336 yes | yes | yes | no
8337 Arguments : none
8338
8339 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8340 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8341 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8342 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8343 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8344 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8345 logged.
8346
8347 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8348 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8349 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008351 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008352 logging.
8353
8354
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008355option dontlognull
8356no option dontlognull
8357 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8359 yes | yes | yes | no
8360 Arguments : none
8361
8362 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8363 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8364 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8365 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8366 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8367 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008368 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8369 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8370 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008371
8372 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008373 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008374 would not be logged.
8375
8376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8378
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008379 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008380 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008381
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008382
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008383option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008384 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8386 yes | yes | yes | yes
8387 Arguments :
8388 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8389 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008390 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008391 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008392
8393 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8394 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8395 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8396 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8397 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8398 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8399 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008400 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8401 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8402 possible that the client has already brought one.
8403
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008404 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008405 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008406 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008407 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008408 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008409 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008410
8411 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8412 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8413 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8414 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8415 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8416 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008417 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008418
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008419 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8420 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008421 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008422 are under the control of the end-user.
8423
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008424 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008425 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8426 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008427 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8428 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8429 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008430
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008431 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008432 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8433 frontend www
8434 mode http
8435 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8436
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008437 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8438 backend www
8439 mode http
8440 option forwardfor header X-Client
8441
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008442 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008443 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008444
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008445
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008446option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8447no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8448 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8450 yes | yes | yes | no
8451 Arguments : none
8452
8453 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8454 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8455 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8456 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8457 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8458 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8459 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8460
8461 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8462 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8463 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8464 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8465 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8466 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8467 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8468 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8469 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8470 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8471
8472 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8473
8474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8476
8477 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8478 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8479
8480
8481option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8482no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8483 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8485 yes | no | yes | yes
8486 Arguments : none
8487
8488 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8489 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8490 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8491 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8492 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8493 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8494 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8495
8496 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8497 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8498 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8499 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8500 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8501 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8502 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8503 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8504 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8505 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8506
8507 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8508
8509 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8510 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8511
8512 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8513 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8514
8515
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008516option http-buffer-request
8517no option http-buffer-request
8518 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8520 yes | yes | yes | yes
8521 Arguments : none
8522
8523 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8524 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8525 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8526 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8527 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8528 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008529 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8530 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8531 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8532 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008533
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008534 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8535 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008536
8537
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008538option http-ignore-probes
8539no option http-ignore-probes
8540 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8542 yes | yes | yes | no
8543 Arguments : none
8544
8545 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8546 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8547 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8548 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8549 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8550 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8551 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8552 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8553 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008554 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8555 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008556 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8557
8558 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8559 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8560 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8561 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8562 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8563 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8564 are often the only way to detect them.
8565
8566 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8567 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8568
8569 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8570
8571
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008572option http-keep-alive
8573no option http-keep-alive
8574 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8576 yes | yes | yes | yes
8577 Arguments : none
8578
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008579 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8580 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008581 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8582 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008583 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8584 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8585 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008586
8587 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8588 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008589 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8590 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8591 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8592 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8593 situations where this option may be useful :
8594
8595 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008596 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008597
8598 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8599 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8600
8601 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8602 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8603 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8604 request.
8605
8606 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8607 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008608 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8609 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8610 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008611
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008612 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8613 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8614 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8615 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8616 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8617 not set.
8618
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008619 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8620 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8621 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008622
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008623 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008624 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008625 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008626
8627
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008628option http-no-delay
8629no option http-no-delay
8630 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8632 yes | yes | yes | yes
8633 Arguments : none
8634
8635 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8636 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8637 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8638 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8639 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8640 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8641 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008642 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008643 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8644 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8645 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8646 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8647 affected.
8648
8649 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8650 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8651 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8652 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8653 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8654 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8655 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8656 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8657 latency environments.
8658
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008659 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8660
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008661
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008662option http-pretend-keepalive
8663no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008664 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008666 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008667 Arguments : none
8668
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008669 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008670 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8671 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8672 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008673 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008674 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8675 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8676 consider the response complete.
8677
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008678 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008679 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008680 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008681 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008682 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008683 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8684
8685 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8686 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8687 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8688 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008689 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8690 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008691 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8692
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008693 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8694 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8695 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8696 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8697 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8698 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008699
8700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8702
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008703 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008704 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008705
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008706
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008707option http-server-close
8708no option http-server-close
8709 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8711 yes | yes | yes | yes
8712 Arguments : none
8713
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008714 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8715 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8716 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8717 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008718 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8719 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8720 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8721 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8722 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8723 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8724 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8725 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8726 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8727 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8728 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008729
8730 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8731 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8732 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8733 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008734 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8735 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008736
8737 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8738 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008739 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8740 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8741 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008742
8743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8745
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008746 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8747 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008748
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008749option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008750no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008751 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8753 yes | yes | yes | no
8754 Arguments : none
8755
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008756 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008757 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8758 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8759 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8760 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8761 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008762 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008763
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008764 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008765 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008766 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8767 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8768 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008769
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008770 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8771 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8772 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8773 front of an existing proxy.
8774
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008775 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8776
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008777 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008778
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008779option httpchk
8780option httpchk <uri>
8781option httpchk <method> <uri>
8782option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008783 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8785 yes | no | yes | yes
8786 Arguments :
8787 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8788 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8789 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8790 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8791 ones.
8792
8793 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8794 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8795 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8796
8797 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8798 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8799 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008800 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008801
8802 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8803 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8804 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8805 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8806 the lack of any response.
8807
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008808 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8809 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8810 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8811 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8812
8813 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8814 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8815 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008816
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008817 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8818 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008819 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008820 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008821 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008822
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008823 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8824 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8825 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8826 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8827
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008828 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008829 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8830 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8831 backend https_relay
8832 mode tcp
8833 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8834 http-check send hdr Host www
8835 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008836
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008837 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8838 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8839 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008840
8841
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008842option httpclose
8843no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008844 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8846 yes | yes | yes | yes
8847 Arguments : none
8848
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008849 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8850 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8851 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8852 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008853 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008854
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008855 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8856 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008857 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008858 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8859 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008860
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008861 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8862 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8863 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008864
8865 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8866 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008867 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8868 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8869 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008870
8871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8873
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008874 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008875
8876
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008877option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008878 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008880 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008881 Arguments :
8882 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8883 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8884 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008885 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008886 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008887
8888 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8889 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8890 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8891 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8892 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8893 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8894 ports.
8895
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008896 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8897 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008898
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008899 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008901 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008902
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008903
8904option http_proxy
8905no option http_proxy
8906 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8908 yes | yes | yes | yes
8909 Arguments : none
8910
8911 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8912 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8913 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8914 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8915 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8916
8917 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8918 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008919 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8920 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008921
8922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8924
8925 Example :
8926 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8927 backend direct_forward
8928 option httpclose
8929 option http_proxy
8930
8931 See also : "option httpclose"
8932
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008933
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008934option independent-streams
8935no option independent-streams
8936 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8938 yes | yes | yes | yes
8939 Arguments : none
8940
8941 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8942 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8943 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8944 receive data or not.
8945
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008946 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008947 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8948 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8949 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8950 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8951 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8952 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8953 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8954 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8955 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8956 socket buffers.
8957
8958 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8959 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8960 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8961 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8962 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8963
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008964 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008965
8966
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008967option ldap-check
8968 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8970 yes | no | yes | yes
8971 Arguments : none
8972
8973 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8974 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8975 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8976 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8977
8978 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8979 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8980
8981 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8982 configure it.
8983
8984 Example :
8985 option ldap-check
8986
8987 See also : "option httpchk"
8988
8989
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008990option external-check
8991 Use external processes for server health checks
8992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8993 yes | no | yes | yes
8994
8995 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8996 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8997 command".
8998
8999 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9000
9001 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9002
9003
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009004option log-health-checks
9005no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009006 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 yes | no | yes | yes
9009 Arguments : none
9010
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009011 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9012 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9013 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009014
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009015 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9016 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9017 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9018 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9019 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9020
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009021 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009022 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009023
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009024 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9025 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9026 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009027
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009028
9029option log-separate-errors
9030no option log-separate-errors
9031 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9033 yes | yes | yes | no
9034 Arguments : none
9035
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009036 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009037 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9038 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9039 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9040 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9041 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9042 provides very important information.
9043
9044 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9045 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9046 error logs.
9047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009048 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009049 logging.
9050
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009051
9052option logasap
9053no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009054 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9056 yes | yes | yes | no
9057 Arguments : none
9058
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009059 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9060 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9061 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9062 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9063
9064 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9065 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9066 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9067 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9068 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009069 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009070 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9071 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9072 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9073 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009074 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009075
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009076 Examples :
9077 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9078 mode http
9079 option httplog
9080 option logasap
9081 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9082
9083 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9084 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9085 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9086 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009088 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009089 logging.
9090
9091
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009092option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009093 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9095 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009096 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009097 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9098 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009099 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9100 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009101
9102 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9103 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009104 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009105 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009106 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9107 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9108 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009109
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009110 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9111 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9112 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009113
9114 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009115 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009116 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9117 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9118 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9119 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9120 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9121 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9122 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9123
9124 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9125 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009126
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009127 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009128
9129 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9130 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9131 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9132 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009133 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009134 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009135
9136 See also: "option httpchk"
9137
9138
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009139option nolinger
9140no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009141 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009142 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9143 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009144 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009145
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009146 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009147 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9148 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9149 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9150 connections.
9151
9152 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9153 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009154 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9155 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9156 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9157 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9158 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9159 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9160 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9161 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9162 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9163 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9164 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9165 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9166 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009167
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009168 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9169 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9170 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9171 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9172 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009173
9174 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9175 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009176 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009177 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009178 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009179
9180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9182
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009183 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9184 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009185
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009186option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9187 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9189 yes | yes | yes | yes
9190 Arguments :
9191 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9192 matching <network>
9193 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9194 header name.
9195
9196 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9197 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9198 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9199 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9200 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9201 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9202 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9203 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9204 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9205 possible that the client has already brought one.
9206
9207 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9208 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9209 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9210 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9211 header and requires different one.
9212
9213 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9214 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9215 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009216 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9217 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9218 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9219 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9220 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009221
9222 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9223 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9224 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9225 both are defined.
9226
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009227 Examples :
9228 # Original Destination address
9229 frontend www
9230 mode http
9231 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9232
9233 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9234 backend www
9235 mode http
9236 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9237
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009238 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009239
9240
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009241option persist
9242no option persist
9243 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9244 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9245 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009246 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009247
9248 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9249 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9250 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9251 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9252 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9253 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9254 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9255 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9256 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9257 redirected to another valid server.
9258
9259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9261
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009262 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009263
9264
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009265option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9266 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9268 yes | no | yes | yes
9269 Arguments :
9270 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9271 PostgreSQL server.
9272
9273 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9274 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9275 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9276 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9277
9278 See also: "option httpchk"
9279
9280
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009281option prefer-last-server
9282no option prefer-last-server
9283 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9285 yes | no | yes | yes
9286 Arguments : none
9287
9288 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009289 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009290 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9291 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009292 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009293 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009294 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009295 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9296 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009297 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009298 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009299 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9300 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9301 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009302 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9303 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9304 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009305
9306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9308
9309 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9310
9311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009312option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009313option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009314no option redispatch
9315 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9316 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9317 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009318 Arguments :
9319 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9320 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9321 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009322 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009323 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009324 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009325 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9326 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9327 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009329
9330 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9331 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9332 be able to access the service anymore.
9333
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009334 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9335 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009336
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009337 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9338 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9339 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9340 following order:
9341
9342 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9343
9344 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9345 list, or
9346
9347 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9348
9349 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9350 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9351
9352 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9353 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9354 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9355 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9356
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009357 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009358 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9359 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9363
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009364 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009365
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009366
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009367option redis-check
9368 Use redis health checks for server testing
9369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9370 yes | no | yes | yes
9371 Arguments : none
9372
9373 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9374 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9375 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9376 find the "+PONG" response message.
9377
9378 Example :
9379 option redis-check
9380
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009381 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009382
9383
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009384option smtpchk
9385option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9386 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9388 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009389 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009390 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009391 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009392 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9393
9394 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9395 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9396 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9397
9398 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9399 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9400 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9401 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9402 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9403 dead server.
9404
9405 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9406 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009407 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009408 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9409
9410 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9411 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9412 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9413 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009414 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009415
9416 Example :
9417 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9418
9419 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9420
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009422option socket-stats
9423no option socket-stats
9424
9425 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9427 yes | yes | yes | no
9428
9429 Arguments : none
9430
9431
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009432option splice-auto
9433no option splice-auto
9434 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9436 yes | yes | yes | yes
9437 Arguments : none
9438
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009439 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009440 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009441 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009442 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009443 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009444 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9445 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9446 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9447 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9448
9449 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9450 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9451 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9452 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9453 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9454 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9455 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9456 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9457 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9458 keyword.
9459
9460 Example :
9461 option splice-auto
9462
9463 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9464 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9465
9466 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9467 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9468
9469
9470option splice-request
9471no option splice-request
9472 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9474 yes | yes | yes | yes
9475 Arguments : none
9476
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009477 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009478 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009479 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9480 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9481 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9482 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9483
9484 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9485
9486 Example :
9487 option splice-request
9488
9489 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9490 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9491
9492 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9493 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9494
9495
9496option splice-response
9497no option splice-response
9498 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9500 yes | yes | yes | yes
9501 Arguments : none
9502
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009503 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009504 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009505 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9506 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9507 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9508 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9509
9510 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9511
9512 Example :
9513 option splice-response
9514
9515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9517
9518 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9519 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9520
9521
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009522option spop-check
9523 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9525 no | no | no | yes
9526 Arguments : none
9527
9528 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9529 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9530 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9531 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9532
9533 Example :
9534 option spop-check
9535
9536 See also : "option httpchk"
9537
9538
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009539option srvtcpka
9540no option srvtcpka
9541 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9543 yes | no | yes | yes
9544 Arguments : none
9545
9546 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9547 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009548 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009549 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9550
9551 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9552 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9553 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9554 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9555
9556 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9557 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9558 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9559 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9560 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9561
9562 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9563
9564 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9565 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9566 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9567
9568 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9569 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9570
9571 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9572
9573
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009574option ssl-hello-chk
9575 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9577 yes | no | yes | yes
9578 Arguments : none
9579
9580 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9581 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9582 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9583 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9584 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9585 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9586 hello message.
9587
9588 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9589 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9590 messages, which is appreciable.
9591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009592 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009593 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9594 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009595
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009596 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9597
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009598
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009599option tcp-check
9600 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9602 yes | no | yes | yes
9603
9604 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9605 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9606
9607 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9608 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9609 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9610
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009611 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009612 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9613 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9614 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9615 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9616 only.
9617
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009618 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009619 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9621 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9622 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9623
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009624 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9626 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009627 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009628 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9629 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9630 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9631 the respective protocols.
9632 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009633 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009634
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009635 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009636
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009637 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9638 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9639 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9640 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009641
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009642 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9643 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9644 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009645
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009646
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009647 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009648 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009649 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009650 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009651
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009652 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009653 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009654 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009655
9656 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9657 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009658 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009659 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009660 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009661 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009662 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009663 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009664 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9665 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009666 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009667 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9668 tcp-check expect string +OK
9669
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009670 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009671 (send many headers before analyzing)
9672 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009673 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009674 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9675 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9676 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9677 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009678 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009679
9680
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009681 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009682
9683
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009684option tcp-smart-accept
9685no option tcp-smart-accept
9686 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9688 yes | yes | yes | no
9689 Arguments : none
9690
9691 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9692 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9693 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9694 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9695 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9696 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9697
9698 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9699 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9700 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9701 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9702
9703 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9704 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9705 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009706 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009707
9708 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9709 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9710 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9711
9712 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9713 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9714 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9715
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009716 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9717
9718
9719option tcp-smart-connect
9720no option tcp-smart-connect
9721 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9723 yes | no | yes | yes
9724 Arguments : none
9725
9726 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9727 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9728 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9729 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9730 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9731
9732 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9733 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9734 complex.
9735
9736 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9737 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9738 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9739
9740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9742
9743 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9744
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009745
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009746option tcpka
9747 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9749 yes | yes | yes | yes
9750 Arguments : none
9751
9752 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9753 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009754 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009755 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9756
9757 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9758 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9759 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9760 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9761
9762 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9763 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9764 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9765 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9766 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9767
9768 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9769
9770 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9771 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9772 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9773 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9774 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9775 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9776 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9777 backends.
9778
9779 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9780
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009781
9782option tcplog
9783 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009785 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009786 Arguments : none
9787
9788 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9789 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9790 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9791 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9792 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9793 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9794 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9795 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9796
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009797 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009799 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009800
9801
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009802option transparent
9803no option transparent
9804 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009806 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009807 Arguments : none
9808
9809 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9810 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9811 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9812 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9813 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9814 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9815 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9816 appropriate server.
9817
9818 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9819 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9820
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009821 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009822 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009823
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009824
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009825external-check command <command>
9826 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9828 yes | no | yes | yes
9829
9830 Arguments :
9831 <command> is the external command to run
9832
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009833 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9834
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009835 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009836
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009837 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9838 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9839 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9840 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9841 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9842 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009843
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009844 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9845
9846 Environment variables :
9847 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9848 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9849
9850 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9851
9852 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9853
9854 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9855 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9856 for a UNIX socket).
9857
9858 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9859
9860 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9861
9862 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9863
9864 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9865
9866 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9867
9868 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9869 socket).
9870
9871 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9872 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9873
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009874 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9875
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009876 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9877 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9878 failed.
9879
9880 Example :
9881 external-check command /bin/true
9882
9883 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9884
9885
9886external-check path <path>
9887 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9889 yes | no | yes | yes
9890
9891 Arguments :
9892 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9893
9894 The default path is "".
9895
9896 Example :
9897 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9898
9899 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9900 "external-check command"
9901
9902
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009903persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009904persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009905 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9907 yes | no | yes | yes
9908 Arguments :
9909 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009910 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9911 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009912
9913 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9914 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009915 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009916 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9917 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9918 forwarded to this server.
9919
9920 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9921 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9922 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009923 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009924 a single "listen" section.
9925
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009926 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9927 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9928 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9929
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009930 Example :
9931 listen tse-farm
9932 bind :3389
9933 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9934 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9935 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9936 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9937 persist rdp-cookie
9938 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009939 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009940 balance rdp-cookie
9941 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9942 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9943
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009944 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9945 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009946
9947
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009948rate-limit sessions <rate>
9949 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9951 yes | yes | yes | no
9952 Arguments :
9953 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9954 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9955
9956 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9957 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9958 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009959 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009960 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9961 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9962
9963 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9964 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9965 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9966 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9967
9968 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9969 listen smtp
9970 mode tcp
9971 bind :25
9972 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009973 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009974
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009975 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9976 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9977 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009978
9979 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9980
9981
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009982redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9983redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9984redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009985 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9987 no | yes | yes | yes
9988
9989 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009990 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009991
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009992 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009993 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009994 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9995 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9996 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009997
9998 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9999 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10000 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10001 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10002 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010003 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10004 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10005 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10006 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010007
10008 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10009 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10010 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10011 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10012 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10013 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010014 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010015 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010016 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10017 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10018 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010019
10020 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010021 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10022 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10023 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010024 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010025 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10026 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10027 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10028 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010029
10030 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010031 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010032
10033 - "drop-query"
10034 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10035 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10036 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10037 with a location-type redirect.
10038
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010039 - "append-slash"
10040 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10041 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10042 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10043 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10044
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010045 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10046 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10047 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10048 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10049 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10050 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10051 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10052
10053 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10054 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10055 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10056 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10057 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10058 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10059 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010060
10061 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10062 acl clear dst_port 80
10063 acl secure dst_port 8080
10064 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010065 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010066 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010067 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10068
10069 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010070 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10071 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10072 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010073 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010074
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010075 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10076 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10077 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10078
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010079 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010080 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010081
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010082 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010083 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10084 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10085 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010087 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010088
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010089
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010090retries <value>
10091 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10093 yes | no | yes | yes
10094 Arguments :
10095 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10096 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10097 default value is 3.
10098
10099 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10100 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10101 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10102
10103 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010104 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10105 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010106
10107 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10108 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10109
10110 See also : "option redispatch"
10111
10112
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010113retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010114 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10115 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10116 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10118 yes | no | yes | yes
10119 Arguments :
10120 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10121 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10122 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10123 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10124
10125 none never retry
10126
10127 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10128 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10129
10130 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10131 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10132 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10133 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10134 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10135 processing the request.
10136
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010137 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10138 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10139 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10140 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10141 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10142 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10143 overflow attack for example).
10144
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010145 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10146 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10147 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10148 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10149 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10150 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10151 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10152 amplify denial of service attacks.
10153
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010154 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10155 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10156 considered to be safe to retry.
10157
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010158 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10159 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10160 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10161 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10162 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010163
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010164 all-retryable-errors
10165 retry request for any error that are considered
10166 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10167 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10168 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10169
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010170 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10171 not cumulative.
10172
10173 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10174 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10175 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10176 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10177
10178 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10179 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10180 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10181 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10182 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10183 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10184 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10185 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10186 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10187 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10188 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10189 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10190
10191 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10192 should not use this directive.
10193
10194 The default is "conn-failure".
10195
10196 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10197
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010198server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010199 Declare a server in a backend
10200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10201 no | no | yes | yes
10202 Arguments :
10203 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010204 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010205 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010206
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010207 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10208 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10209 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10210 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010211 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10212 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010213 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010214 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10215 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010216 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10217 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10218 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10219 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10220 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10221 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10222 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010223 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010224 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10225 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10226 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10227 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10228 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10229 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010230 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10231 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010232 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10233 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010234
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010235 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010236 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10237 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10238 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10239 adding this value to the client's port.
10240
10241 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10242 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010243 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010244
10245 Examples :
10246 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10247 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010248 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010249 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10250 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10251 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010252
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010253 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10254 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10255 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10256 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10257 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10258
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010259 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10260 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010261
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010262server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010263 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010264 this backend.
10265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10266 no | no | yes | yes
10267
10268 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10269 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10270 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10271 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10272 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010273
10274 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10275 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10276
10277 global
10278 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10279
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010280 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010281 load-server-state-from-file
10282
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010283 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010284 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010285
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010286server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10287 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10288 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10290 no | no | yes | yes
10291
10292 Arguments:
10293 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10294
10295 <num | range>
10296 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10297 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10298 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10299 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10300
10301 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10302
10303 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10304
10305 <params*>
10306 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10307 keyword.
10308
10309 Examples:
10310 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10311 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10312 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10313
10314 # or
10315 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10316
10317 # would be equivalent to:
10318 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10319 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10320 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10321
10322
10323
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010324source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010325source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010326source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010327 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10329 yes | no | yes | yes
10330 Arguments :
10331 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10332 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010333
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010334 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010335 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10336 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10337 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10338 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10339 supported prefixes are :
10340 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10341 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10342 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010343 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010344 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10345 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010346
10347 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10348 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010349 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10350 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10351 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010352
10353 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10354 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10355 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10356 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10357 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10358 <addr>.
10359
10360 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10361 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10362 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10363 port.
10364
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010365 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10366 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10367 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10368 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010369 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010370 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10371 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10372 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10373 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10374 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10375 HTTP header.
10376
10377 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10378 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010379 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010380 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10381 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10382 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10383 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10384 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10385 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10386 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10387
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010388 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10389 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10390 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10391 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10392 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10393 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10394
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010395 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10396 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10397 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10398 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10399
10400 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10401 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10402 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10403 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10404 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10405 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10406
10407 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10408 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10409 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10410 there are two methods :
10411
10412 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10413 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10414 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10415 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10416 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10417 of the client ranges may be used.
10418
10419 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10420 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10421 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10422 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10423 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10424 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10425 same session.
10426
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010427 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10428 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10429 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010430 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010432 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10433
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010434 Examples :
10435 backend private
10436 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10437 source 192.168.1.200
10438
10439 backend transparent_ssl1
10440 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10441 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10442
10443 backend transparent_ssl2
10444 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10445 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10446 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10447
10448 backend transparent_ssl3
10449 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10450 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10451 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10452
10453 backend transparent_smtp
10454 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10455 # with Tproxy version 4.
10456 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10457
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010458 backend transparent_http
10459 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10460 # proxy.
10461 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010463 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010464 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10465
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010466
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010467srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10468 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10469 the connection on the server side.
10470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10471 yes | no | yes | yes
10472 Arguments :
10473 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10474
10475 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10476 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010477 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10478 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010479
10480 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10481
10482
10483srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10484 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10485 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10486 server side.
10487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10488 yes | no | yes | yes
10489 Arguments :
10490 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10491 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10492 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10493 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10494
10495 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10496 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010497 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10498 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010499
10500 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10501
10502
10503srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10504 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10506 yes | no | yes | yes
10507 Arguments :
10508 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10509 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10510 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10511 document.
10512
10513 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10514 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010515 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10516 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010517
10518 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10519
10520
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010521stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10522 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010524 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010525
10526 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10527 matched.
10528
10529 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10530 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010532 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10533 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010534 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010535
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010536 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10537 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10538 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10539 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010540
10541 Example :
10542 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10543 backend stats_localhost
10544 stats enable
10545 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10546
10547 Example :
10548 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10549 backend stats_auth
10550 stats enable
10551 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10552 stats admin if TRUE
10553
10554 Example :
10555 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10556 userlist stats-auth
10557 group admin users admin
10558 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10559 group readonly users haproxy
10560 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10561
10562 backend stats_auth
10563 stats enable
10564 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10565 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10566 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10567 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10568
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010569 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10570 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10571 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010572
10573
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010574stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10575 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010577 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010578 Arguments :
10579 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10580
10581 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10582
10583 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10584 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10585 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10586 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10587 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10588 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10589
10590 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10591 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10592 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010593 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010594
10595 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10596 report using "stats scope".
10597
10598 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10599 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10600 unobvious parameters.
10601
10602 Example :
10603 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10604 backend public_www
10605 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10606 stats enable
10607 stats hide-version
10608 stats scope .
10609 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010610 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010611 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10612 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10613
10614 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10615 backend private_monitoring
10616 stats enable
10617 stats uri /admin?stats
10618 stats refresh 5s
10619
10620 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10621
10622
10623stats enable
10624 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010627 Arguments : none
10628
10629 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10630 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10631 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10632 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10633 - stats auth : no authentication
10634 - stats scope : no restriction
10635
10636 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10637 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10638 unobvious parameters.
10639
10640 Example :
10641 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10642 backend public_www
10643 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10644 stats enable
10645 stats hide-version
10646 stats scope .
10647 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010648 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010649 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10650 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10651
10652 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10653 backend private_monitoring
10654 stats enable
10655 stats uri /admin?stats
10656 stats refresh 5s
10657
10658 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10659
10660
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010661stats hide-version
10662 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010664 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010665 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010666
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010667 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10668 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10669 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10670 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10671 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10672 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010674 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10675 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10676 unobvious parameters.
10677
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010678 Example :
10679 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10680 backend public_www
10681 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010682 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010683 stats hide-version
10684 stats scope .
10685 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010686 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010687 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10688 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010689
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010690 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10691 backend private_monitoring
10692 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010693 stats uri /admin?stats
10694 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010695
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010696 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010697
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010698
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010699stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10700 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10701 Access control for statistics
10702
10703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10704 no | no | yes | yes
10705
10706 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10707 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10708 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10709 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10710 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10711 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10712
10713 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10714 instance.
10715
10716 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10717 about ACL usage.
10718
10719
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010720stats realm <realm>
10721 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010724 Arguments :
10725 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10726 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10727 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10728
10729 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10730 using a backslash ('\').
10731
10732 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10733 only related to authentication.
10734
10735 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10736 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10737 unobvious parameters.
10738
10739 Example :
10740 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10741 backend public_www
10742 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10743 stats enable
10744 stats hide-version
10745 stats scope .
10746 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010747 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010748 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10749 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10750
10751 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10752 backend private_monitoring
10753 stats enable
10754 stats uri /admin?stats
10755 stats refresh 5s
10756
10757 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10758
10759
10760stats refresh <delay>
10761 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010763 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010764 Arguments :
10765 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10766 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10767 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10768 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10769 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10770 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10771
10772 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10773 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10774 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010775 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010776
10777 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10778 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10779 unobvious parameters.
10780
10781 Example :
10782 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10783 backend public_www
10784 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10785 stats enable
10786 stats hide-version
10787 stats scope .
10788 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010789 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010790 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10791 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10792
10793 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10794 backend private_monitoring
10795 stats enable
10796 stats uri /admin?stats
10797 stats refresh 5s
10798
10799 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10800
10801
10802stats scope { <name> | "." }
10803 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010805 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010806 Arguments :
10807 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10808 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10809 section in which the statement appears.
10810
10811 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10812 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10813 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10814 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10815 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10816 exists.
10817
10818 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10819 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10820 unobvious parameters.
10821
10822 Example :
10823 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10824 backend public_www
10825 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10826 stats enable
10827 stats hide-version
10828 stats scope .
10829 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010830 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010831 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10832 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10833
10834 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10835 backend private_monitoring
10836 stats enable
10837 stats uri /admin?stats
10838 stats refresh 5s
10839
10840 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10841
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010842
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010843stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010844 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010846 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010847
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010848 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010849 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10850
10851 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10852 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10853
10854 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10855 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010856 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010857
10858 Example :
10859 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10860 backend private_monitoring
10861 stats enable
10862 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10863 stats uri /admin?stats
10864 stats refresh 5s
10865
10866 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10867 global section.
10868
10869
10870stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010871 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10873 yes | yes | yes | yes
10874 Arguments : none
10875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010876 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010877 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10878 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10879 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10880 - IP (socket, server)
10881 - cookie (backend, server)
10882
10883 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10884 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010885 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010886
10887 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10888
10889
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010890stats show-modules
10891 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10893 yes | yes | yes | yes
10894 Arguments : none
10895
10896 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10897 values as a tooltip.
10898
10899 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10900 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10901 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10902
10903 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10904
10905
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010906stats show-node [ <name> ]
10907 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010909 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010910 Arguments:
10911 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10912 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10913
10914 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10915 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010917
10918 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10919 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10920 unobvious parameters.
10921
10922 Example:
10923 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10924 backend private_monitoring
10925 stats enable
10926 stats show-node Europe-1
10927 stats uri /admin?stats
10928 stats refresh 5s
10929
10930 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10931 section.
10932
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010933
10934stats uri <prefix>
10935 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010937 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010938 Arguments :
10939 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10940 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10941 query string.
10942
10943 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10944 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10945 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10946 possible to reach it in the application.
10947
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010948 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010949 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010950 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10951 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10952 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10953 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10954
10955 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10956 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10957 an address or a port to statistics only.
10958
10959 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10960 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10961 unobvious parameters.
10962
10963 Example :
10964 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10965 backend public_www
10966 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10967 stats enable
10968 stats hide-version
10969 stats scope .
10970 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010972 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10973 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10974
10975 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10976 backend private_monitoring
10977 stats enable
10978 stats uri /admin?stats
10979 stats refresh 5s
10980
10981 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10982
10983
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010984stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10985 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010987 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010988
10989 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010990 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010991 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010992 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010993 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10994
10995 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10996 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10997 the "stick-table" statement.
10998
10999 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11000 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11001 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11002 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11003 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11004
11005 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11006 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11007 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11008 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11009 transformation rules.
11010
11011 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11012 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11013 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11014 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11015 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11016 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11017 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11018
11019 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11020 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11021 ACL based conditions.
11022
11023 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11024 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11025 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11026 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11027
11028 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11029 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11030 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11031 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11032
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011033 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11034 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011035 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011036
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011037 Example :
11038 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11039 # last 30 minutes
11040 backend pop
11041 mode tcp
11042 balance roundrobin
11043 stick store-request src
11044 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11045 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11046 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11047
11048 backend smtp
11049 mode tcp
11050 balance roundrobin
11051 stick match src table pop
11052 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11053 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11054
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011055 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011056 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011057
11058
11059stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11060 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11062 no | no | yes | yes
11063
11064 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11065 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11066 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11067 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11068
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011069 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11070 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011071 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011072
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011073 Examples :
11074 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011075 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011076
11077 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11078 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11079 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11080
11081
11082 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11083 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11084 backend http
11085 mode http
11086 balance roundrobin
11087 stick on src table https
11088 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11089 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11090 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11091
11092 backend https
11093 mode tcp
11094 balance roundrobin
11095 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11096 stick on src
11097 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11098 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11099
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011100 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011101
11102
11103stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11104 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11106 no | no | yes | yes
11107
11108 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011109 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011110 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011111 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011112 server is selected.
11113
11114 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11115 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11116 the "stick-table" statement.
11117
11118 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11119 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11120 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11121 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11122 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11123 address.
11124
11125 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11126 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11127 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11128 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11129 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11130 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11131 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11132 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11133 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11134 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11135
11136 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11137 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11138 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11139 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11140 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11141 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11142 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11143
11144 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11145 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11146 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11147 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11148
11149 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11150 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11151 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11152 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11153 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11154 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011155 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11156 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11157 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11158 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11159 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11160 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011161
11162 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11163 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11164 the request.
11165
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011166 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11167 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011169
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011170 Example :
11171 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11172 # last 30 minutes
11173 backend pop
11174 mode tcp
11175 balance roundrobin
11176 stick store-request src
11177 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11178 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11179 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11180
11181 backend smtp
11182 mode tcp
11183 balance roundrobin
11184 stick match src table pop
11185 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11186 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11187
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011188 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011189 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011190
11191
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011192stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011193 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011194 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011195 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011197 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011198
11199 Arguments :
11200 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11201 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11202 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11203 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11204
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011205 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11206 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11207 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11208 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11209
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011210 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11211 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11212 instance.
11213
11214 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11215 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11216 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11217 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11218 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11219 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011220 to 32 characters.
11221
11222 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11223 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11224 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011225 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011226 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11227 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011228
11229 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011230 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11231 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011232 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11233 increase.
11234
11235 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011236 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11237 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11238 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011239
11240 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011241 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011242 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11243 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011244 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011245 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11246 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11247 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11248 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11249 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11250 parameter (see below).
11251
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011252 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11253 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11254 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11255 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11256 soft restart.
11257
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011258 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11259 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011260
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011261 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11262 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11263 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11264 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011265 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011266 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011267 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11268 if not expiration delay is specified.
11269
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011270 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11271 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11272 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11273 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11274 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11275 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11276 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11277 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11278 token.
11279
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011280 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11281 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11282 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11283 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011284 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11285 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11286 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11287 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11288 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11289 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11290 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11291 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11292 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11293 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11294 types and their arguments.
11295
11296 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11297 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11298 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11299 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11300
11301 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11302 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11303 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011304 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011305
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011306 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11307 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11308 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011309 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011310 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011311 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011312
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011313 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11314 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11315 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11316 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11317
11318 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11319 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11320 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11321 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11322 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11323 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11324
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011325 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11326 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11327 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11328 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11329
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011330 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11331 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11332 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11333 they were received.
11334
11335 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11336 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11337 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11338 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11339 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11340
11341 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11342 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11343 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11344 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11345 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11346
11347 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11348 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11349 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11350
11351 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11352 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11353 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11354 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11355 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11356
11357 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11358 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11359 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11360 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11361 the client side.
11362
11363 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11364 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11365 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11366 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11367 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11368 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11369 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11370
11371 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11372 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11373 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11374 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11375 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11376 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011377 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011378
11379 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11380 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11381 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11382 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11383 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11384 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11385
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011386 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11387 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11388 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11389 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11390 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11391
11392 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11393 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11394 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11395 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11396 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11397 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11398
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011399 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011400 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011401 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11402 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11403
11404 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11405 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11406 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11407 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11408 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11409 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11410 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11411 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11412 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11413 recommended for better fairness.
11414
11415 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011416 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011417 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11418 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11419
11420 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11421 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11422 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11423 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11424 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11425 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11426 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11427 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11428 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11429 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011430
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011431 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11432 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011433 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11434 reference it.
11435
11436 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11437 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011438 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11439 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11440 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011441
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011442 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11443 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11444 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11445 something that can be ignored.
11446
11447 Example:
11448 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11449 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11450 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11451 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11452
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011453 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011454 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011455
11456
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011457stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011458 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11460 no | no | yes | yes
11461
11462 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011463 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011464 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011465 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011466 server is selected.
11467
11468 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11469 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11470 the "stick-table" statement.
11471
11472 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11473 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11474 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11475 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11476
11477 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11478 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11479 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11480 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11481 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11482 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011483 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011484 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11485 rules.
11486
11487 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11488 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11489 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11490 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11491 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11492 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11493 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11494
11495 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11496 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11497 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11498 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11499
11500 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11501 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11502 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11503 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11504 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11505 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011506 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11507 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11508 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11509 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11510 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11511 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11512 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11513 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11514 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011515
11516 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11517
11518 Example :
11519 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11520 backend https
11521 mode tcp
11522 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011523 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011524 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011525
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011526 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11527 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11528
11529 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11530 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11531 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11532
11533 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11534 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011535
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011536 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11537 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11538 # at offset 44.
11539
11540 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11541 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11542
11543 # Learn on response if server hello.
11544 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011545
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011546 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11547 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11548
11549 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11550 extraction.
11551
11552
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011553tcp-check comment <string>
11554 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11555 it fails.
11556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11557 yes | no | yes | yes
11558
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011559 Arguments :
11560 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11561 rule fails.
11562
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011563 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11564 user-friendly error reporting.
11565
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011566 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11567 "tcp-check expect".
11568
11569
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011570tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11571 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011572 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011573 Opens a new connection
11574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011575 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011576
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011577 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011578 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11579
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011580 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011581 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011582
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011583 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011584 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11585 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011586 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011587
11588 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011589
11590 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11591
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011592 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11593
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011594 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11595
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011596 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11597
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011598 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11599 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11600 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11601 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11602
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011603 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11604 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11605 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11606 haproxy -vv.
11607
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011608 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011609
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011610 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11611 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11612 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11613
11614 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11615 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11616 of the sequence.
11617
11618 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11619 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11620 do.
11621
11622 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11623 unset-var or comment rules.
11624
11625 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011626 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11627 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11628 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11629 option tcp-check
11630 tcp-check connect
11631 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11632 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11633 tcp-check send \r\n
11634 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11635 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11636 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11637 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11638 tcp-check send \r\n
11639 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11640 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11641
11642 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11643 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011644 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011645 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11646 tcp-check connect port 143
11647 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11648 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11649
11650 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11651
11652
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011653tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011654 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011655 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011656 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011657 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011658 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011659 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011660
11661 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011662 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11663
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011664 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11665 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11666 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11667 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11668 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11669 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11670 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11671 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11672 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11673 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11674
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011675 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011676 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11677 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011678 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11679 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11680 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11681
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011682 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11683 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11684 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011685 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11686 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011687 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11688 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011689 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11690 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011691 By default "L7OK" is used.
11692
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011693 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11694 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011695 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11696 supported :
11697 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11698 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011699 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11700 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11701 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11702 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11703 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011704
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011705 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011706 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011707 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11708 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11709 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11710 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011711 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11712
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011713 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11714 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11715 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11716 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11717
11718 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11719 informational message reported in logs if an error
11720 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11721 log-format string.
11722
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011723 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11724 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11725 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11726 followed by some converters.
11727
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011728 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11729 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11730 with the usual backslash ('\').
11731 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011732 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011733 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11734 used upper or lower case.
11735
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011736 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11737
11738 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11739 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11740 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11741 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11742 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11743 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11744 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11745 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11746
11747 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11748 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11749 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11750 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11751 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11752 expression.
11753
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011754 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11755 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11756 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11757 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11758 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11759 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11760
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011761 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11762 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11763 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11764 this exact hexadecimal string.
11765 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11766
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011767 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11768 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11769 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11770 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11771 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11772 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11773 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11774 size.
11775
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011776 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11777 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11778 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11779 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11780 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11781 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11782 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11783 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11784 in a binary string before matching the response's
11785 buffer.
11786
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011787 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011788 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011789 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11790 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11791 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11792 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11793 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11794 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11795 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11796 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11797 the null character.
11798
11799 Examples :
11800 # perform a POP check
11801 option tcp-check
11802 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11803
11804 # perform an IMAP check
11805 option tcp-check
11806 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11807
11808 # look for the redis master server
11809 option tcp-check
11810 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011811 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011812 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11813 tcp-check expect string role:master
11814 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11815 tcp-check expect string +OK
11816
11817
11818 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011819 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011820
11821
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011822tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11823tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11824 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11825 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011827 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011828
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011829 Arguments :
11830 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11831
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011832 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11833 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011834
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011835 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11836 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011837
11838 Examples :
11839 # look for the redis master server
11840 option tcp-check
11841 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11842 tcp-check expect string role:master
11843
11844 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011845 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011846
11847
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011848tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11849tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11850 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11851 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011853 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011854
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011855 Arguments :
11856 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011857
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011858 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11859 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011860
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011861 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11862 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11863 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011864
11865 Examples :
11866 # redis check in binary
11867 option tcp-check
11868 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11869 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11870
11871
11872 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011873 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011874
11875
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011876tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011877 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011878 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011879 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011880
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011881 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011882 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11883 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11884 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11885 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11886 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11887 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11888 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11889 and '-'.
11890
11891 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11892
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011893 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011894 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11895
11896
11897tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011898 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011899 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011900 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011901
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011902 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011903 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11904 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11905 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11906 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11907 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11908 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11909 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11910 and '-'.
11911
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011912 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011913 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11914
11915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011916tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11917 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11919 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011920 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011921 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11922 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011924 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011925
11926 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11927 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011928 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11929 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11930 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11931 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11932 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11933 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011934
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011935 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11936 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11937 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11938 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011939
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011940 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011941 - accept :
11942 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11943 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11944 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011946 - reject :
11947 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11948 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11949 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11950 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11951 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11952 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11953 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11954 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11955 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11956 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11957 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011958 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011959
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011960 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11961 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11962 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11963 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11964 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11965 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11966 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11967 hosts.
11968
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011969 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11970 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11971 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11972 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11973 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11974 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11975 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11976 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11977
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011978 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11979 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11980 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11981 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11982 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11983 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11984 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11985 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11986 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011987 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11988 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011989
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011990 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011991 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011992 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11993 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11994 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011995 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011996 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011997 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11998 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11999 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12000 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12001 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12002 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12003 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012005 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012006 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012007 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012008 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012009 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12010 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12011 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012013 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12014 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12015 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12016 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012018 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12019 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12020 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12021 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12022 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012023 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12024 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12025 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12026 layer7 information is extracted.
12027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012028 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12029 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12030 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12031 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12032 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012033
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012034 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12035 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12036 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12037 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12038
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012039 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12040 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12041 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12042 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12043
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012044 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12045 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12046 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12047 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12048 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012049
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012050 - set-src <expr> :
12051 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12052 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12053 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012054 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012056 Arguments:
12057 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12058 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012059
12060 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012061 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12062
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012063 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12064 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012065
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012066 - set-src-port <expr> :
12067 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12068 expression.
12069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012070 Arguments:
12071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12072 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012073
12074 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012075 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12076
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012077 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12078 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12079 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012080
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012081 - set-dst <expr> :
12082 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12083 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12084 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12085 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12086 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12087
12088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12089 followed by some converters.
12090
12091 Example:
12092
12093 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12094 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12095
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012096 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12097 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12098
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012099 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12100 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12101 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12102 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12103
12104
12105 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12106 followed by some converters.
12107
12108 Example:
12109
12110 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12111
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012112 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12113 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12114 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12115
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012116 - "silent-drop" :
12117 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012118 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012119 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12120 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12121 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12122 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12123 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012124 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12125 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012126 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12127 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012128 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012129 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12130 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12131 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12132 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012134 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12135 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12136 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012138 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12139 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12140 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012142 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012143 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012144 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012146 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12147 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12148 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012149
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012150 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012151 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12152 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012153
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012154 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12155
12156 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12157
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012158 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12159
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012160 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012161
12162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012163tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12164 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012166 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012167 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012168 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12169 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012170
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012171 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012172
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012173 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012174 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12175 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012176 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12177 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012178
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012179 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12180 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12181 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12182 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012183 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012184 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012185 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12186 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12187 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12188 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012189 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012190 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012192 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12193 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12194 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12195 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012196
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012197 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012198 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012199 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012200 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12201 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012202 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012203 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012204 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012205 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012206 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012207 - set-dst <expr>
12208 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012209 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012210 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012211 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012212 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012213 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012214 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012216 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12217 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012218 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12219 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012220
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012221 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12222 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12223 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12224 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12225 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12226 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012228 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012229 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12230 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012231
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012232 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12233 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12234 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12235 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12236 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12237 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12238
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012239 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012240 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12241 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12242 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12243 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12244 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12245 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12246 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12247 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12248 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12249 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012250
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012251 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012252 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12253 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12254 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012255
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012256 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12257 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12258
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012259 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012260 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12261 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012262
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012263 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12264 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12267 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012268 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012269 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012270 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012271 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12272 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012273 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012274 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12275 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012276
12277 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12278 followed by some converters.
12279
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012280 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012281 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12282 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12283 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12284 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12285 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12286 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012287 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012288 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12289 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12290
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012291 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12292
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012293 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12294 <var-name>.
12295
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012296 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12297 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12298 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12299 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12300 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12301
12302 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12303 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12304 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12305 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12306 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12307 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12308 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12309 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12310 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12311 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12312 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12313
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012314 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12315 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12316 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12317 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12318 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12319
12320 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12321
12322 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12323
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012324 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12325 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12326 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12327 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12328 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12329 evaluated.
12330
12331 Example:
12332 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12333
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012334 Example:
12335
12336 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012337 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012338
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012339 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012340 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012341 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012342 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12343 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012344 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012345 tcp-request content reject
12346
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012347 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12348 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12349 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12350 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12351 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12352 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12353 ...
12354 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012356 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012357 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12358 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12359 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012360 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012361
12362 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12363 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12364 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012365 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012366 tcp-request content reject
12367
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012368 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012369 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012370 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012371 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012372 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12373 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012374
12375 Example:
12376 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12377 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012378 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012379
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012380 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012381 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012382
12383 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012384 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012385 # protecting all our sites
12386 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012387 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12388 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012389 ...
12390 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12391
12392 backend http_dynamic
12393 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012394 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012395 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012396 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012397 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012398 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012399 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012401 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012402
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012403 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12404 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012405
12406
12407tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12408 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012410 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012411 Arguments :
12412 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12413 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12414 as explained at the top of this document.
12415
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012416 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012417 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12418 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12419 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12420 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12421
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012422 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12423 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12424 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12425 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12426
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012427 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012428 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012429 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012430 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012431 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012432 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12433 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12434 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012435
12436 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12437 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12438 it pass through unaffected.
12439
12440 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12441 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12442 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012443 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012444 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12445 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012446 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12447 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12448 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012449
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012450 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012451 "timeout client".
12452
12453
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012454tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12455 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12457 no | no | yes | yes
12458 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012459 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12460 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012461
12462 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012464 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012465 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12466 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012467 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12468 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012469
12470 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12471
12472 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12473 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12474 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12475 inserted.
12476
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012477 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012478 - accept :
12479 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12480 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12481 the rules evaluation.
12482
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012483 - close :
12484 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12485 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12486 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12487 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12488 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12489 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012490 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012491 protocols.
12492
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012493 - reject :
12494 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12495 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012496 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012497
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012498 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12499 Sets a variable.
12500
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012501 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12502 Unsets a variable.
12503
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012504 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12505 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12506 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12507 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12508
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012509 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12510 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12511 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12512 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12513
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012514 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12515 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12516 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12517 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12518 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012519
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012520 - "silent-drop" :
12521 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012522 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012523 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12524 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12525 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12526 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12527 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012528 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12529 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012530 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12531 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012532 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012533 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12534 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12535 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12536 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12537
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012538 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12539 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12540
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012541 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12542 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12543 for changing the default action to a reject.
12544
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012545 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12546 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12547 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12548 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012549 period.
12550
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012551 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12552 declared inline.
12553
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012554 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12555 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012556 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012557 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12558 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012559 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012560 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012561 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012562 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12563 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012564 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012565 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12566 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012567
12568 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12569 followed by some converters.
12570
12571 Example:
12572
12573 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12574
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012575 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12576 <var-name>.
12577
12578 Example:
12579
12580 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12581
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012582 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12583 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12584 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12585 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12586 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12587
12588 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12589
12590 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12591
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012592 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12593
12594 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12595
12596
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012597tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12598 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12600 no | yes | yes | no
12601 Arguments :
12602 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12603 below.
12604
12605 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12606
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012607 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012608 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12609 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12610 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12611 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12612 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12613 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12614 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012615 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012616 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12617 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12618 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12619 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12620 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12621 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12622 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12623 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12624 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12625 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12626 instead.
12627
12628 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12629 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12630 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12631 rules which may be inserted.
12632
12633 Several types of actions are supported :
12634 - accept : the request is accepted
12635 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12636 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12637 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012638 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012639 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012640 - set-dst <expr>
12641 - set-dst-port <expr>
12642 - set-src <expr>
12643 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012644 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012645 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012646 - silent-drop
12647
12648 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12649 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12650 sections for a complete description.
12651
12652 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12653 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12654 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12655
12656 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12657 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12658 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12659 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12660 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12661
12662 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12663 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12664
12665 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12666 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12667 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12668
12669 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12670 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12671 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12672
12673 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12674 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12675 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12676
12677 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12678 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12679 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12680
12681 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12682
12683 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12684
12685
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012686tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12687 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12689 no | no | yes | yes
12690 Arguments :
12691 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12692 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12693 as explained at the top of this document.
12694
12695 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12696
12697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012698timeout check <timeout>
12699 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12700 established.
12701
12702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12703 yes | no | yes | yes
12704 Arguments:
12705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12707 as explained at the top of this document.
12708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012709 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012710 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012711 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012712 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012713 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12714 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12715 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012716
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012717 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012718 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12719
12720 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12721 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012722 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012723
12724 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12725 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12726 forget about it.
12727
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012728 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12729 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012730
12731
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012732timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012733 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12735 yes | yes | yes | no
12736 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012737 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012738 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12739 as explained at the top of this document.
12740
12741 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12742 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12743 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012744 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12745 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12746 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12747 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012748 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12749 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12750 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012751 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012752 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012753 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12754 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012755 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12756 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012757
12758 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12759 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12760 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12761 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012762 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012763 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12764
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012765 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012766
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012767 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012769
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012770timeout client-fin <timeout>
12771 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12773 yes | yes | yes | no
12774 Arguments :
12775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12777 as explained at the top of this document.
12778
12779 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12780 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12781 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12782 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12783 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12784 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12785 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012786 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12787 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12788 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012789
12790 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12791 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12792 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12793
12794 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12795
12796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012797timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012798 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12800 yes | no | yes | yes
12801 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12804 as explained at the top of this document.
12805
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012806 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012807 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012808 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012809 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012810 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12811 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012812
12813 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12814 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12815 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12816 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012817 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012818 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12819
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012820 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012822
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012823timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12824 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12826 yes | yes | yes | yes
12827 Arguments :
12828 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12829 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12830 as explained at the top of this document.
12831
12832 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12833 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12834 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12835 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12836 once the request has started to present itself.
12837
12838 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12839 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12840 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12841 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12842 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12843
12844 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12845 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12846 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12847 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12848
12849 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12850 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012851 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012852 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12853 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012854 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012855
12856 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12857 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12858 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12859 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12860
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012861 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12862 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012863 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12864
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012865 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12866
12867
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012868timeout http-request <timeout>
12869 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012872 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012873 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012874 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12875 as explained at the top of this document.
12876
12877 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12878 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12879 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12880 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12881 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12882 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12883 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012884 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12885 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12886 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12887 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012888 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012889 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12890 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012891
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012892 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12893 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12894 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12895 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12896 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012897 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012898
12899 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12900 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012901 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012902 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12903 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12904
12905 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012906 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12907 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12908 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012909
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012910 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012911 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012912
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012913
12914timeout queue <timeout>
12915 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12917 yes | no | yes | yes
12918 Arguments :
12919 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12920 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12921 as explained at the top of this document.
12922
12923 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12924 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12925 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12926 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12927 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12928
12929 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12930 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12931 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12932 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12933
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012934 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012935
12936
12937timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012938 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12940 yes | no | yes | yes
12941 Arguments :
12942 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12943 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12944 as explained at the top of this document.
12945
12946 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12947 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12948 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12949 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12950 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12951 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12952 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12953
12954 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12955 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12956 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12957 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12958 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012959 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012960 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012961 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12962 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012963 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12964 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012965
12966 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12967 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12968 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12969 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012970 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012971 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12972
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012973 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012974
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012975
12976timeout server-fin <timeout>
12977 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12979 yes | no | yes | yes
12980 Arguments :
12981 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12982 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12983 as explained at the top of this document.
12984
12985 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12986 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12987 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12988 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12989 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12990 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12991 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12992 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12993 situations, it should not be needed.
12994
12995 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12996 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12997 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12998
12999 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13000
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013001
13002timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013003 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13005 yes | yes | yes | yes
13006 Arguments :
13007 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13008 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13009 as explained at the top of this document.
13010
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013011 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13012 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13013 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013014
13015 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13016 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13017 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13018 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013019 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013020
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013021 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013022
13023
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013024timeout tunnel <timeout>
13025 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13027 yes | no | yes | yes
13028 Arguments :
13029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13031 as explained at the top of this document.
13032
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013033 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013034 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13035 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13036 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013037 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13038 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013039 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13040 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13041 specified.
13042
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013043 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13044 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13045 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13046 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13047 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13048 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13049 state.
13050
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013051 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13052 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13053 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13054 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013055 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013056
13057 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13058 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13059 forget about it.
13060
13061 Example :
13062 defaults http
13063 option http-server-close
13064 timeout connect 5s
13065 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013066 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013067 timeout server 30s
13068 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13069
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013070 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013071
13072
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013073transparent (deprecated)
13074 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013076 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013077 Arguments : none
13078
13079 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13080 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13081 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13082 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13083 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13084 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13085 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13086 appropriate server.
13087
13088 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13089
13090 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13091 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13092
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013093 See also: "option transparent"
13094
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013095unique-id-format <string>
13096 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13098 yes | yes | yes | no
13099 Arguments :
13100 <string> is a log-format string.
13101
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013102 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13103 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13104 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13105 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013106
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013107 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013108 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013109 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13110 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13111 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13112 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13113 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13114 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013115
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013116 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13117 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013118
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013119 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013120
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013121 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013122
13123 will generate:
13124
13125 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13126
13127 See also: "unique-id-header"
13128
13129unique-id-header <name>
13130 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13132 yes | yes | yes | no
13133 Arguments :
13134 <name> is the name of the header.
13135
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013136 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13137 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013138
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013139 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013140
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013141 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013142 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13143
13144 will generate:
13145
13146 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13147
13148 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013149
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013150use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013151 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13153 no | yes | yes | no
13154 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013155 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13156 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013157
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013158 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13159 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013160
13161 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13162 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13163 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013164 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013165 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013166 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13167 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013168
13169 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13170 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13171 assign the backend.
13172
13173 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13174 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13175 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13176 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13177 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13178 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13179
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013180 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013181 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013182 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13183 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13184 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13185
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013186 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13187 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13188 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13189 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13190 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13191 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13192 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13193 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13194 cannot be forced from the request.
13195
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013196 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013197 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13198 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13199
13200 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13201 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013202
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013203use-fcgi-app <name>
13204 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13206 no | no | yes | yes
13207 Arguments :
13208 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13209
13210 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013211
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013212use-server <server> if <condition>
13213use-server <server> unless <condition>
13214 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13216 no | no | yes | yes
13217 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013218 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13219 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013220
13221 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13222
13223 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13224 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13225 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13226
13227 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13228 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13229 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13230 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13231 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13232 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13233 matches will assign the server.
13234
13235 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13236 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13237 with the next rules until one matches.
13238
13239 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13240 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13241 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13242 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13243
13244 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13245 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13246 stripped.
13247
13248 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13249 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013250 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013251 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013252 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013253
13254 Example :
13255 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013256 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013257 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013258 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013259 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013260 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013261 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013262 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13263 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13264
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013265 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13266 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13267 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13268 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013269 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013270 and we fall back to load balancing.
13271
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013272 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013273
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132755. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013276--------------------------
13277
13278The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13279depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13280settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13281written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13282described in this section.
13283
13284
132855.1. Bind options
13286-----------------
13287
13288The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13289as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13290no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13291parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13292while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13293provided immediately after the setting name.
13294
13295The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13296
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013297accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13298 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13299 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13300 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13301 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13302 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13303 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13304 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13305 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13306 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013307 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13308 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13309 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013310
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013311accept-proxy
13312 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013313 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13314 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013315 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13316 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13317 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13318 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013319 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013320 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13321 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013322 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13323 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013324
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013325allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013326 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013327 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013328 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013329 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13330 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013331
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013332alpn <protocols>
13333 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13334 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13335 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013336 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013337 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013338 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13339 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13340 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13341 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13342 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13343 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13344 preference, like below :
13345
13346 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013348backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013349 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013350 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13351
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013352curves <curves>
13353 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13354 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13355 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13356 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13357 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13358 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13359
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013360ecdhe <named curve>
13361 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013362 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13363 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013364
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013365ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13367 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13368 client's certificate.
13369
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013370ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13372 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13373 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13374 error is ignored.
13375
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013376ca-sign-file <cafile>
13377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13378 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13379 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13380 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13381 'generate-certificates' for details.
13382
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013383ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13385 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13386 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13387 'generate-certificates' for details.
13388
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013389ca-verify-file <cafile>
13390 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13391 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13392 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13393 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13394 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13395
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013396ciphers <ciphers>
13397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13398 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013399 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013400 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013401 information and recommendations see e.g.
13402 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13403 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13404 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13405
13406ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13407 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13408 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13409 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13410 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013411 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13412 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013413
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013414crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13416 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013417 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13418 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013420crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13422 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13423 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13424 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13425 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013426 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13427 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013428
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013429 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13430 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13431
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013432 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13433 are loaded.
13434
13435 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013436 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13437 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13438 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13439 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13440 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13441 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13442 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013443 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013444
13445 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13446 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13447 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13448 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013449 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13450 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013451
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013452 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013453
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013454 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013455 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013456 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13457 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013458 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13459 clients).
13460
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013461 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013462 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13463 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13464 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13465 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13466 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13467 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13468 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13469 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13470 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13471 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13472 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13473 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13474
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013475 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013476 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13477 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13478 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13479 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13480
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013481 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13482 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13483 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13484 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013485
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013486 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13487 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13488 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013489
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013490crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013492 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013493 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013494 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013495
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013496crt-list <file>
13497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013498 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13499 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013500
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013501 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13502
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013503 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13504 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13505 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13506 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13507 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013508
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013509 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013510 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13511 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13512 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13513 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13514 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013515 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13516 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13517 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013518
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013519 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13520 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13521 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013522
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013523 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13524
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013525 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013526 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013527 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13528 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13529 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13530 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13531 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13532 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013533
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013534 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013535 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013536 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013537 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013538 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013539 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013540
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013541defer-accept
13542 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13543 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13544 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013545 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013546 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13547 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13548 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13549 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13550 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13551 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13552 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13553
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013554expose-fd listeners
13555 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13556 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013557 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13558 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013559 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013560
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013561force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013562 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013563 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013564 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013565 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013566
13567force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013568 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013569 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013570 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013571
13572force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013573 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013574 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013575 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013576
13577force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013578 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013579 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013580 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013581
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013582force-tlsv13
13583 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13584 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013585 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013586
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013587generate-certificates
13588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13589 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13590 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13591 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13592 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13593 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13594 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13595 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13596 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13597 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13598 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13599
13600 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13601 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013602 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013603 certificate is used many times.
13604
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013605gid <gid>
13606 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13607 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13608 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13609 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13610 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13611
13612group <group>
13613 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13614 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13615 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13616 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13617 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13618
13619id <id>
13620 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13621 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13622 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13623 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13624
13625interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013626 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13627 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13628 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13629 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13630 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13631 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013632 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13633 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13634 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13635 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13636 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13637 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013638
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013639level <level>
13640 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13641 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13642 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013644 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13645 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13646 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013647 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013648 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013649 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013650 all counters).
13651
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013652severity-output <format>
13653 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13654 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13655 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13656 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13657 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13658 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13659 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13660 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13661 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13662 rfc5424 convention.
13663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013664maxconn <maxconn>
13665 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13666 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13667 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13668 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13669 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13670 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13671 eat all memory.
13672
13673mode <mode>
13674 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13675 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13676 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13677 UNIX sockets.
13678
13679mss <maxseg>
13680 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13681 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13682 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13683 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13684 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13685 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13686 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13687 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13688 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13689 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13690 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13691
13692name <name>
13693 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13694 page.
13695
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013696namespace <name>
13697 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13698 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13699 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13700 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13701
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013702nice <nice>
13703 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13704 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13705 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13706 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13707 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13708 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13709 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13710 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13711 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13712 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13713 one for an RDP socket.
13714
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013715no-ca-names
13716 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13717 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013718 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013719
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013720no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013722 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013723 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013724 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013725 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13726 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013727
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013728no-tls-tickets
13729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13730 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13731 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013732 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13733 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013734 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13735 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13736 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013737
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013738no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013740 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013741 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013742 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013743 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13744 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013745
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013746no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013748 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013749 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013750 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013751 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13752 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013753
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013754no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013756 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013757 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013758 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013759 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13760 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013761
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013762no-tlsv13
13763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13764 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13765 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13766 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013767 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13768 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013769
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013770npn <protocols>
13771 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13772 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13773 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013774 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013775 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013776 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13777 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13778 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13779 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13780 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013781
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013782prefer-client-ciphers
13783 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13784 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13785 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013786 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13787 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13788 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013789
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013790process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013791 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013792 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013793 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013794 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13795 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13796 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13797 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013798 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013799 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13800 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13801 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13802 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13803 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013804
13805 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13806
13807 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13808 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13809 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13810 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13811 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13812 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13813 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13814 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013815
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013816proto <name>
13817 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13818 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13819 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013820 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13821 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13822
13823 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13824 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13825 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13826 also reported (flag=HTX).
13827
13828 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13829 a bind line :
13830
13831 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13832 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13833 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13834
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013835 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013836 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013837 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013838 h2" on the bind line.
13839
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013840ssl
13841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013842 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013843 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13844 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013845 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13846 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013847
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013848ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13849 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013850 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13851 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13852 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013853 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13854
13855ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013856 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13857 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13858 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13859 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013860
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013861strict-sni
13862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13863 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13864 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13865 See the "crt" option for more information.
13866
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013867tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013868 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013869 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013870 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013871 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013872 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13873 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13874 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13875 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13876 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13877 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13878 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13879
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013880tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013881 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013882 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13883 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13884 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13885 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13886 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13887 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13888 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013889 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13890 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13891 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013892
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013893tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13894 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013895 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13896 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13897 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13898 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13899 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13900 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13901 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13902 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13903 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13904 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013905 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13906 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13907
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013908transparent
13909 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13910 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13911 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13912 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13913 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13914 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13915 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13916 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13917 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13918 so check for support with your vendor.
13919
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013920v4v6
13921 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13922 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13923 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13924 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013925 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013926
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013927v6only
13928 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13929 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13930 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013931 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13932 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013933
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013934uid <uid>
13935 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13936 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13937 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13938 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13939 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13940
13941user <user>
13942 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13943 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13944 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13945 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13946 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13947
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013948verify [none|optional|required]
13949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13950 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13951 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13952 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13953 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013954 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13955 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13956 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13957 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013958
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200139595.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013960------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013962The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13963which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13964arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13965settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13966after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13967Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13968address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013970 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013971 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013972
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013973Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13974keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013976The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013977
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013978addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013979 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013980 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13981 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13982 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13983 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13984 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013985
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013986agent-check
13987 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013988 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013989 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13990 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13991 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013992
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013993 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013994 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013995 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013996 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13997 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013998
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013999 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14000 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14001 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14002 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14003 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014004
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014005 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014006 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014007
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014008 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14009 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14010 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014011
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014012 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14013 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14014 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014015
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014016 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014017 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14018 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14019 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14020 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014021 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014022 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014023
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014024 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14025 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014026
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014027 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14028 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14029 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14030 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14031 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14032 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14033 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14034 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14035 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014036
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014037 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14038 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014039 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14040 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14041 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014042 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014043
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014044 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014045 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014046
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014047agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014048 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014049 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14050 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14051 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14052 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14053
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014054agent-inter <delay>
14055 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14056 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14057
14058 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14059 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14060 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14061 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14062 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14063 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14064 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14065 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14066 of backends use the same servers.
14067
14068 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14069
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014070agent-addr <addr>
14071 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14072
14073 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014074 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014075 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14076 hostname, it will be resolved.
14077
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014078agent-port <port>
14079 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14080
14081 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14082
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014083allow-0rtt
14084 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014085 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14086 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014087
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014088alpn <protocols>
14089 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14090 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14091 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014092 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014093 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14094 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14095 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14096 now obsolete NPN extension.
14097 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14098 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14099
14100 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014102backup
14103 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14104 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14105 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14106 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014107 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14108 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014109
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014110ca-file <cafile>
14111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14112 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14113 server's certificate.
14114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014115check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014116 This option enables health checks on a server:
14117 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14118 considered available.
14119 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14120 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14121 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14122 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14123 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14124 set.
14125 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14126 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14127 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14128 exchanges succeed.
14129
14130 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14131 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14132 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14133 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14134 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014135 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014136 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14137
14138 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14139 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14140
14141 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14142 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14143
14144 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14145 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14146 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14147 available.
14148
14149 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14150 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14151 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14152
14153 Example:
14154 # simple tcp check
14155 backend foo
14156 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14157 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14158 backend foo
14159 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14160 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14161 backend foo
14162 option tcp-check
14163 tcp-check connect
14164 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014165
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014166check-send-proxy
14167 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14168 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14169 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14170 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14171 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14172 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14173 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14174
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014175check-alpn <protocols>
14176 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14177 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14178 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14179
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014180check-proto <name>
14181 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14182 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14183 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014184 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14185 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14186
14187 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14188 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14189 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14190 also reported (flag=HTX).
14191
14192 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14193 directive on a server line:
14194
14195 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14196 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14197 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14198 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14199
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014200 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014201 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14202 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14203
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014204check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014205 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014206 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14207 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014208
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014209check-ssl
14210 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14211 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14212 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14213 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014214 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014215 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14216 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014217 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014218 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14219 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014220
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014221check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014222 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014223 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14224 for normal traffic.
14225
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014226ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14228 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14229 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014230 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14231 information and recommendations see e.g.
14232 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14233 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14234 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014235
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014236ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14238 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14239 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14240 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014241 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14242 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14243 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014245cookie <value>
14246 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14247 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14248 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14249 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14250 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14251 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14252 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14253
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014254crl-file <crlfile>
14255 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14256 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14257 to verify server's certificate.
14258
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014259crt <cert>
14260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14261 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14262 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14263 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14264 certificate request.
14265
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014266 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14267 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14268 option is set accordingly).
14269
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014270disabled
14271 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14272 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14273 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14274 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14275 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014276 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014277
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014278enabled
14279 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14280 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14281 default value.
14282 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14283 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014285error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014286 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14287 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14288 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014290 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014292fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014293 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14294 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14295 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14296
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014297force-sslv3
14298 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14299 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014300 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014301 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014302
14303force-tlsv10
14304 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014305 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014306 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014307
14308force-tlsv11
14309 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014310 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014311 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014312
14313force-tlsv12
14314 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014315 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014316 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014317
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014318force-tlsv13
14319 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14320 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014321 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014323id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014324 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14325 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14326 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014327
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014328init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14329 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14330 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014331 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014332 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14333 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14334 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14335 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14336 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14337 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14338 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14339 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14340 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014341 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014342 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14343 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14344 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14345 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14346 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14347 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014348 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014349
14350 Example:
14351 defaults
14352 # never fail on address resolution
14353 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014355inter <delay>
14356fastinter <delay>
14357downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014358 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14359 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14360 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14361 between checks depending on the server state :
14362
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014363 Server state | Interval used
14364 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14365 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14366 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14367 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14368 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14369 or yet unchecked. |
14370 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14371 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14372 | "inter" otherwise.
14373 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014375 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14376 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14377 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14378 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014379 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14380 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14381 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14382 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14383 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014384
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014385log-proto <logproto>
14386 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14387 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14388 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14389 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014391maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014392 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14393 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014394 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14395 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014396 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14397 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14398 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14399 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14400
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014401 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14402 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14403 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14404 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14405 than 50 concurrent requests.
14406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014407maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014408 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14409 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14410 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14411 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014412 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14413 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14414 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14415 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14416 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14417 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14418 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014419
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014420max-reuse <count>
14421 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14422 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14423 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14424 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14425 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14426 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14427 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14428 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14429
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014430minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014431 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14432 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14433 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14434 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14435 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14436 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014437 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014438 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014439
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014440namespace <name>
14441 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14442 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14443 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14444 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14445
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014446no-agent-check
14447 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14448 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14449 default value.
14450 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14451 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14452
14453no-backup
14454 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14455 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14456 default value.
14457 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14458 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14459
14460no-check
14461 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14462 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14463 default value.
14464 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14465 "default-server" "check" setting.
14466
14467no-check-ssl
14468 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14469 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14470 default value.
14471 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14472 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14473
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014474no-send-proxy
14475 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14476 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14477 default value.
14478 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14479 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14480
14481no-send-proxy-v2
14482 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14483 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14484 default value.
14485 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14486 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14487
14488no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14489 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14490 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14491 default value.
14492 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14493 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14494
14495no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14496 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14497 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14498 default value.
14499 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14500 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14501
14502no-ssl
14503 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14504 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14505 default value.
14506 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14507 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14508
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014509 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14510 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14511 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14512
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014513no-ssl-reuse
14514 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14515 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14516 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14517 and for paranoid users.
14518
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014519no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014520 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14521 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014522 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014523
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014524 Supported in default-server: No
14525
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014526no-tls-tickets
14527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14528 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14529 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014530 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14531 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014532 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14533 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14534 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014535 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014536
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014537no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014538 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014539 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14540 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014541 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14542 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014543 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014544
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014545 Supported in default-server: No
14546
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014547no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014548 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014549 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14550 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014551 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14552 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014553 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014554
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014555 Supported in default-server: No
14556
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014557no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014558 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014559 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14560 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014561 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14562 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014563 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014564
14565 Supported in default-server: No
14566
14567no-tlsv13
14568 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14569 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14570 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14571 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14572 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014573 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014574
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014575 Supported in default-server: No
14576
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014577no-verifyhost
14578 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14579 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14580 default value.
14581 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14582 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014583
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014584no-tfo
14585 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14586 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14587 default value.
14588 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14589 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14590
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014591non-stick
14592 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14593 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14594 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14595
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014596npn <protocols>
14597 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14598 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14599 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014600 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014601 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14602 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14603 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014605observe <mode>
14606 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14607 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14608 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14609 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14610 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14611 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014612 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014613
14614 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014616on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014617 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14618 Currently, four modes are available:
14619 - fastinter: force fastinter
14620 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14621 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14622 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14623 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14624
14625 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14626
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014627on-marked-down <action>
14628 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14629 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014630 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14631 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14632 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14633 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14634 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14635 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14636 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14637 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014638
14639 Actions are disabled by default
14640
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014641on-marked-up <action>
14642 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14643 Currently one action is available:
14644 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14645 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14646 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14647 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014648 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14649 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014650 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14651 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14652
14653 Actions are disabled by default
14654
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014655pool-low-conn <max>
14656 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14657 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14658 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14659 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14660 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14661 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14662 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14663 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14664 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14665 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014666 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14667 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14668 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14669 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014670
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014671pool-max-conn <max>
14672 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14673 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14674 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14675 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14676 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14677 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14678
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014679pool-purge-delay <delay>
14680 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014681 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014682 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014684port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014685 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014686 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14687 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14688 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14689 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14690 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014691
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014692proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014693 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14694 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14695 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014696 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14697 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14698
14699 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14700 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14701 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14702 also reported (flag=HTX).
14703
14704 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14705 a server line :
14706
14707 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14708 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14709 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14710 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14711
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014712 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014713 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014715redir <prefix>
14716 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14717 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14718 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14719 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14720 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14721 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14722 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14723 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014724 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014725 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014726 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14727 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14728 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14729 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14730
14731 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014733rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014734 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14735 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14736 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14737
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014738resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14739 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14740 server.
14741
14742 Available options:
14743
14744 * allow-dup-ip
14745 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14746 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14747 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14748 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14749 For such case, simply enable this option.
14750 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14751
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014752 * ignore-weight
14753 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14754 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14755 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14756
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014757 * prevent-dup-ip
14758 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14759 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14760 same fqdn.
14761 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14762
14763 Example:
14764 backend b_myapp
14765 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14766 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14767 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14768
14769 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14770 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14771 it
14772 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14773 different address
14774
14775 Default value: not set
14776
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014777resolve-prefer <family>
14778 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14779 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14780 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14781 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14782
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014783 Default value: ipv6
14784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014785 Example:
14786
14787 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014788
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014789resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014790 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014791 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014792 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014793 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14794 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014795 configured network, another address is selected.
14796
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014797 Example:
14798
14799 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014800
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014801resolvers <id>
14802 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14803 hostname.
14804
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014805 Example:
14806
14807 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014808
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014809 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014810
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014811send-proxy
14812 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14813 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14814 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14815 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014816 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14817 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14818 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14819 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014820 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014821 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14822 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14823 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14824 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14825 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014826 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14827 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014828
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014829send-proxy-v2
14830 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14831 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14832 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14833 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014834 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14835 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14836 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14837 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014838
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014839proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014840 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14841 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14842
14843 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14844 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14845 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14846 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14847 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14848 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14849 connection is supported).
14850 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14851 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14852 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14853 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14854 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14855 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14856 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014857
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014858send-proxy-v2-ssl
14859 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14860 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14861 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14862 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14863 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14864 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14865 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014866 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14867 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014868
14869send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14870 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14871 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14872 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14873 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14874 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14875 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14876 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14877 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014878 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14879 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014880
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014881slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014882 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14883 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14884 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14885 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14886 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14887 parameters :
14888
14889 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14890 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14891
14892 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14893 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14894 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14895 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14896
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014897 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014898 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14899 seen as failed.
14900
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014901sni <expression>
14902 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14903 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14904 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14905 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014906 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14907 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014908 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014909 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14910 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014911
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014912source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014913source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014914source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014915 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14916 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14917 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14918 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14919
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014920 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14921 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14922 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14923 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14924 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14925 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14926 server.
14927
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014928 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14929 specifying the source address without port(s).
14930
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014931ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014932 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14933 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14934 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14935 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14936 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14937 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014938 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14939 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014940
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014941ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14942 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14943 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14944 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14945
14946ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14947 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14948 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14949 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14950
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014951ssl-reuse
14952 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14953 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14954 default value.
14955 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14956 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14957
14958stick
14959 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14960 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14961 default value.
14962 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14963 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014964
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014965socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014966 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014967 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14968 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14969
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014970tcp-ut <delay>
14971 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014972 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014973 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014974 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014975 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14976 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14977 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14978 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14979 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14980 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14981 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14982 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14983 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14984
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014985tfo
14986 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14987 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14988 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14989 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014990 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014991 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014993track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014994 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14995 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14996 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14997 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014998 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14999
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015000tls-tickets
15001 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15002 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15003 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015004 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15005 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15006 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015007 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015008 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015009
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015010verify [none|required]
15011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015012 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015013 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15014 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015015 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015016 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15017 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15018 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15019 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15020 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15021 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15022 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15023 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015024
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015025verifyhost <hostname>
15026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015027 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15028 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15029 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15030 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15031 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15032 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15033 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15034 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015036weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015037 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15038 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15039 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015040 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15041 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15042 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15043 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15044 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15045 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015046
15047
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150485.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15049-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015050
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015051HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15052using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015053configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015054This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15055can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15056workload.
15057This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15058resolution at run time.
15059Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15060carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15061
15062
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150635.3.1. Global overview
15064----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015065
15066As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15067different steps of the process life:
15068
15069 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15070 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15071 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15072
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015073 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15074 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015075
15076A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15077 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15078 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15079 resolution to know this new IP.
15080
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015081When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015082HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015083SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15084from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015085will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015086will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015087
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015088A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015089 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015090 first valid response.
15091
15092 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15093 servers return an error.
15094
15095
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150965.3.2. The resolvers section
15097----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015098
15099This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015100HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15101contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015102
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015103When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15104uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15105is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15106answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15107
15108When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015109used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015110
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015111 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15112 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15113 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015114
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015115 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15116 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015117
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015118 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15119 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15120 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015121
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015122For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15123following scenarios are possible:
15124
15125 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15126 ignored
15127
15128 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15129 applied
15130
15131 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15132 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15133
15134 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15135 retries the query with a new type
15136
15137 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15138 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015139
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015140As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015141a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015142<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015143
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015144
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015145resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015146 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015147
15148A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15149
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015150accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015151 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015152 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015153 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15154 by RFC 6891)
15155
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015156 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15157 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15158 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15159 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15160 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15161 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015162
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015163nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15164 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15165 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15166 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15167 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15168 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15169 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15170 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15171 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15172 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015173 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15174
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015175parse-resolv-conf
15176 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15177 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15178 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15179
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015180hold <status> <period>
15181 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15182 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015183 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015184 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015185 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15186 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15187 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15188
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015189 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015190
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015191resolve_retries <nb>
15192 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15193 giving up.
15194 Default value: 3
15195
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015196 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15197 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15198 type.
15199
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015200timeout <event> <time>
15201 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15202 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15203 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015204 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15205 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015206 Default value: 1s
15207 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015208 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015209 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015210 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15211 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15212
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015213 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015214
15215 resolvers mydns
15216 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15217 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015218 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015219 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015220 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015221 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015222 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015223 hold other 30s
15224 hold refused 30s
15225 hold nx 30s
15226 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015227 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015228 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015229
15230
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200152316. Cache
15232---------
15233
15234HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15235(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15236RAM.
15237
15238The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15239this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15240
15241If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15242independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15243when we try to allocate a new one.
15244
15245The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15246
15247It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15248"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15249for more details.
15250
15251When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15252replaced by "<CACHE>".
15253
15254
152556.1. Limitation
15256----------------
15257
15258The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15259
15260- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015261- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15262 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15263 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015264- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15265- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015266- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15267 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15268 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015269- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15270 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015271- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15272 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15273 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015274
15275- If the request is not a GET
15276- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15277- If the request contains an Authorization header
15278
15279
152806.2. Setup
15281-----------
15282
15283To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15284the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15285
15286
152876.2.1. Cache section
15288---------------------
15289
15290cache <name>
15291 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15292 size of cache is mandatory.
15293
15294total-max-size <megabytes>
15295 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15296 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15297
15298max-object-size <bytes>
15299 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15300 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15301 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15302
15303max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015304 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015305 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15306 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15307 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15308 default.
15309
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015310process-vary <on/off>
15311 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015312 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15313 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15314 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015315 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015316
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015317max-secondary-entries <number>
15318 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15319 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15320 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15321
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015322
153236.2.2. Proxy section
15324---------------------
15325
15326http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15327 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15328 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15329 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15330 after this one.
15331
15332http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15333 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15334 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15335 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15336 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15337
15338
15339Example:
15340
15341 backend bck1
15342 mode http
15343
15344 http-request cache-use foobar
15345 http-response cache-store foobar
15346 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15347
15348 cache foobar
15349 total-max-size 4
15350 max-age 240
15351
15352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153537. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15354----------------------------------
15355
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015356HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015357client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15358The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15359these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15360but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15361data called patterns.
15362
15363
153647.1. ACL basics
15365---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015366
15367The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15368content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15369from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15370simple :
15371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015373 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15375 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015377The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15378adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015379
15380In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015383
15384This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15385Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15386and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015387an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15388conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15389as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15390are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015391
15392ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15393'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15394which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15395
15396There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15397performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15400specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15401this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015402methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15403ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015404
15405Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15406 - boolean
15407 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15408 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15409 - string
15410 - data block
15411
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015412Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15413converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15414would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15415The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15416which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15417
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015418Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15419keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15420fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15421which are summarized in the table below :
15422
15423 +---------------------+-----------------+
15424 | Sample or converter | Default |
15425 | output type | matching method |
15426 +---------------------+-----------------+
15427 | boolean | bool |
15428 +---------------------+-----------------+
15429 | integer | int |
15430 +---------------------+-----------------+
15431 | ip | ip |
15432 +---------------------+-----------------+
15433 | string | str |
15434 +---------------------+-----------------+
15435 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15436 +---------------------+-----------------+
15437
15438Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15439matching method, see below.
15440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15442 - boolean
15443 - integer or integer range
15444 - IP address / network
15445 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15446 - regular expression
15447 - hex block
15448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015449The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15450
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015451 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15452 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015453 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015454 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015455 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015456 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015457 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15460read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15461if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15462lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15463will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15464beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015465a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15467exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15468
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015469The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15470parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15471ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15472a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15473check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15474
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015475The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15476socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15477file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15480loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15481
15482 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15483
15484In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15485the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15486case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15487as well.
15488
15489The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15490sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15491do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15492methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15493is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015494obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15496default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15497that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15498string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15499
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015500The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15501By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15502string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15503resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015504server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015505waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015506flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15507function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15510sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15511be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015512
15513 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15514 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15516 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15517 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15518 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015519
15520 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15521 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015522 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015523
15524 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015526
15527 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015529
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015530 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015531 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15532
15533 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15534 binary or string samples.
15535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15537 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15540 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15541 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15544 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15547 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015549 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15550 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15553 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015554 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15557 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15558 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015559
15560For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15561request, it is possible to do :
15562
15563 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15564
15565In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15566buffer, one would use the following acl :
15567
15568 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15569
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015570On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15571possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15572
15573 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15576criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15577method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15578to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15579criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15580the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015583the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15584For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015586 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15587 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15588 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15589 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015590
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015591
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015592The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15593types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15594combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15595brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15596default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598 +-------------------------------------------------+
15599 | Input sample type |
15600 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015601 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15603 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15604 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015605 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015607 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015609 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015611 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015613 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015615 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015617 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015619 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015621 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015623 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015625 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15627 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15628 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015629
15630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156317.1.1. Matching booleans
15632------------------------
15633
15634In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15635Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15636When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15637that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15638
15639Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15640return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15641"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156447.1.2. Matching integers
15645------------------------
15646
15647Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15648enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15649to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15650
15651Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15652matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15653lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015654
15655For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15656unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15657representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15658
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015659As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15660two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15661instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15662ranges and operators.
15663
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015664For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015665operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15666Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15667of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015669Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015670
15671 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15672 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15673 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15674 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15675 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015677For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015678
15679 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15680
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015681This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15682
15683 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156867.1.3. Matching strings
15687-----------------------
15688
15689String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15690different forms :
15691
15692 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015693 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694
15695 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015696 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697
15698 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15699 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15700
15701 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15702 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15703
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015704 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15706 matches.
15707
15708 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15709 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15710 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015711
15712String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15713exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15714characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15715string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15716to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015717before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015718
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015719Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15720(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15721Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15722
15723Example:
15724 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15725 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157287.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15729---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015730
15731Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15732they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15733possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15734passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15735the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015736the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15737match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015738
15739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157407.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15741-------------------------------------
15742
15743It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15744not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15745a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15746to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15747digits may be used upper or lower case.
15748
15749Example :
15750 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15751 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15752
15753
157547.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15755---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015756
15757IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15758netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15759within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015760host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015761difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15762at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15763does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15764parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015765
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015766The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15767abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15768
15769 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15770 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15771 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15772 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15773 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15774 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15775 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15776 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15777
15778Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15779192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15780
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015781IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15782Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15783trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15784IPv6 patterns.
15785
15786HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15787following situations :
15788 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15789 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15790 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15791 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15792 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15793 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15794 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15795 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15796 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15797 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015799
158007.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15801----------------------------------
15802
15803Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15804combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15805
15806 - AND (implicit)
15807 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15808 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15815indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15818"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15819requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15820is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15821
15822 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015823 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15824 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15825 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826
15827To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15828and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15829
15830 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15831 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15832 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15833 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15834
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015835 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15837 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15838 use_backend www if host_www
15839
15840It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15841expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15842be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15843the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15844
15845 The following rule :
15846
15847 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015848 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015849
15850 Can also be written that way :
15851
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015852 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015853
15854It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15855to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15856simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15857sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15858good use is the following :
15859
15860 With named ACLs :
15861
15862 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15863 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15864 monitor fail if site_dead
15865
15866 With anonymous ACLs :
15867
15868 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15869
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015870See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15871keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872
15873
158747.3. Fetching samples
15875---------------------
15876
15877Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15878against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15879sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15880ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15881of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15882available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15883
15884This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15885Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15886compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15887deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15888
15889The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15890matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15891method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15892indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15893
15894As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15895when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15896mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15897the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15898ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15899
15900Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15901multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15902when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015903incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15904are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15906all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15907
15908Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15909 - name
15910 - name(arg1)
15911 - name(arg1,arg2)
15912
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015913
159147.3.1. Converters
15915-----------------
15916
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015917Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15918of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15919is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15920was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015921has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015922unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15923
15924These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15925sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15926the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015927support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015928
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015929A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15930support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15931supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15932(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15933bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015936
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001593751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15938 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15939 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15940 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15941 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15942 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15943
15944 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015945 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15946 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015947 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15948 frontend http-in
15949 bind *:8081
15950 default_backend servers
15951 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15952 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15953
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015954add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015955 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015956 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015957 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15958 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015959 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015960 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15961 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15962 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15963 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015964 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015965 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015966
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015967aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15968 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15969 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15970 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15971 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15972 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15973 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15974
15975 Example:
15976 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15977 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15978
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015979and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015980 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015981 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015982 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15983 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015984 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015985 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15986 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15987 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15988 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015989 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015990 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015991
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015992b64dec
15993 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15994 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015995 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15996 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015997
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015998base64
15999 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016000 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016001 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16002 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016003
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016004bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016005 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016006 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016007 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016008 presence of a flag).
16009
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016010bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16011 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16012 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016013 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016014
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016015concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16016 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16017 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16018 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16019 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16020 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16021 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16022 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16023 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16024 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16025 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016026 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016027 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016028 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16029 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016030
16031 Example:
16032 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16033 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16034 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016035 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016036 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16037
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016038cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016039 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16040 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016041
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016042crc32([<avalanche>])
16043 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16044 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16045 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16046 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16047 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16048 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16049 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16050 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16051 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16052 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016053 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16054
16055crc32c([<avalanche>])
16056 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16057 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16058 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16059 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16060 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16061 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16062 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16063 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016064
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016065cut_crlf
16066 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16067 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16068 updated.
16069
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016070da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016071 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16072 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16073 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16074 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016075 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016076 configuration language.
16077
16078 Example:
16079 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016080 bind *:8881
16081 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016082 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016083
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016084debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16085 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16086 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16087 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16088 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16089 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16090 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16091 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16092 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16093 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16094 printable sample types.
16095
16096 Example:
16097 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016098
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016099digest(<algorithm>)
16100 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16101 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16102
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016103 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016104 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16105
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016106div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016107 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16108 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016109 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016110 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16111 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016112 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016113 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16114 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16115 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16116 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016117 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016118 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016119
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016120djb2([<avalanche>])
16121 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16122 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16123 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16124 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16125 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16126 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16127 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016128 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16129 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016130
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016131even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016132 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016133 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16134
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016135field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16136 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16137 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16138 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16139 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16140 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16141 fields.
16142
16143 Example :
16144 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16145 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16146 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16147 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16148 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016149
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016150fix_is_valid
16151 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16152 Information eXchange):
16153
16154 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16155 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016156 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016157 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016158 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016159 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16160 checksum
16161
16162 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16163 the server can be parsed.
16164
16165 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16166 message, false if not.
16167
16168 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16169
16170 Example:
16171 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16172 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16173
16174fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16175 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16176 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16177 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16178 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016179 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016180 added.
16181
16182 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16183 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16184 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16185 fix_is_valid converter.
16186
16187 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16188
16189 Example:
16190 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16191 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16192 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16193 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16194 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16195
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016196hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016197 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016198 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016199 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016200 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016201
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016202hex2i
16203 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016204 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016205
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016206htonl
16207 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16208 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16209 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16210 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16211
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016212hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016213 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16214 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16215 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16216 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16217
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016218 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016219 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16220
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016221http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016222 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16223 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016224 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16225 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16226 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16227 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16228 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16229 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16230 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16231 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016232
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016233iif(<true>,<false>)
16234 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16235 string otherwise.
16236
16237 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016238 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016239
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016240in_table(<table>)
16241 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16242 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16243 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016244 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016245 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16246
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016247ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016248 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016249 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016250 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16251 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16252 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16253 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16254 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016255
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016256json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016257 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016258 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016259 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016260 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16261 of errors:
16262 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16263 bytes, ...)
16264 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16265 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16266
16267 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16268 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16269 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16270 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16271 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16272 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016273 - "ascii" : never fails;
16274 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16275 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016276 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016277 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016278 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16279 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16280
16281 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016282 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016283
16284 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016285 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016286 capture request header user-agent len 150
16287 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016288
16289 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16290 GET / HTTP/1.0
16291 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16292
16293 Output log:
16294 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16295
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016296json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16297 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16298 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16299 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16300 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16301
16302 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16303 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16304
16305 Example:
16306 # get a integer value from the request body
16307 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16308 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16309
16310 # get a key with '.' in the name
16311 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16312 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16313
16314 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16315 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16316
16317 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16318 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16319
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016320language(<value>[,<default>])
16321 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16322 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16323 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16324 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16325 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16326 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16327 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16328 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16329 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016330 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016331 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16332 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016334 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016336 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16337 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016339 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16340 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16341 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16342 use_backend spanish if es
16343 use_backend french if fr
16344 use_backend english if en
16345 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016346
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016347length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016348 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16349 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16350 type. The result is of type integer.
16351
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016352lower
16353 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16354 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16355 type. The result is of type string.
16356
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016357ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16358 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16359 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16360 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16361 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16362 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16363 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16364
16365 Example :
16366
16367 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016368 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016369 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16370
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016371ltrim(<chars>)
16372 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16373 representation of the input sample.
16374
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016375map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16376map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16377map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16378 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16379 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16380 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16381 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16382 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16383 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16384 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16385 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016386
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016387 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16388 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16389 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016390
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016391 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016392 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016393
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016394 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16395 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16396 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16397 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016398 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16399 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016400 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16401 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16402 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16403 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16404 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16405 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16406 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16407 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016408 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16409 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16410 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016411 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16412 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16413 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16414 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16415 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016416
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016417 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16418 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16419 the corresponding match text.
16420
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016421 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16422 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16423 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16424 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16425 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016426
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016427 Example :
16428
16429 # this is a comment and is ignored
16430 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16431 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16432 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16433 | | | `---------- value
16434 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16435 | `---------------------------- key
16436 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16437
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016438mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016439 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16440 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016441 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016442 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016443 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016444 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16445 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16446 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16447 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016448 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016449 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016450
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016451mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016452 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16453 <packettype>.
16454 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16455 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16456 from.
16457 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16458 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16459 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16460
16461 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16462 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16463 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16464 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16465
16466 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16467 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16468 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16469 packets only):
16470 17: Session Expiry Interval
16471 33: Receive Maximum
16472 39: Maximum Packet Size
16473 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16474 25: Request Response Information
16475 23: Request Problem Information
16476 21: Authentication Method
16477 22: Authentication Data
16478 18: Will Delay Interval
16479 1: Payload Format Indicator
16480 2: Message Expiry Interval
16481 3: Content Type
16482 8: Response Topic
16483 9: Correlation Data
16484 Not supported yet:
16485 38: User Property
16486
16487 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16488 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16489 packets only):
16490 17: Session Expiry Interval
16491 33: Receive Maximum
16492 36: Maximum QoS
16493 37: Retain Available
16494 39: Maximum Packet Size
16495 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16496 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16497 31: Reason String
16498 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16499 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16500 42: Shared Subscription Available
16501 19: Server Keep Alive
16502 26: Response Information
16503 28: Server Reference
16504 21: Authentication Method
16505 22: Authentication Data
16506 Not supported yet:
16507 38: User Property
16508
16509 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16510 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16511 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16512 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16513
16514 Example:
16515
16516 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16517 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16518 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16519 if data_in_buffer
16520 # do the same as above
16521 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16522 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16523 if data_in_buffer
16524
16525mqtt_is_valid
16526 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16527
16528 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16529 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16530 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16531 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16532
16533 Example:
16534
16535 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016536 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016537
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016538mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016539 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016540 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16541 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016542 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016543 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016544 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016545 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16546 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16547 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16548 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016550 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016551
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016552nbsrv
16553 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16554 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16555 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16556 map lookup.
16557
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016558neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016559 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16560 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16561 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16562 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016563
16564not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016565 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016566 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016567 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016568 absence of a flag).
16569
16570odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016571 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016572 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16573
16574or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016575 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016576 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016577 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16578 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016579 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016580 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16581 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16582 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16583 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016584 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016585 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016586
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016587protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16588 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16589 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16590 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16591 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16592 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16593 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16594 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16595 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16596 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16597 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16598 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16599
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016600regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016601 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16602 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16603 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16604 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16605 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16606 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16607 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16608 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16609 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016610 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16611 of characters with other ones.
16612
16613 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16614 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16615 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16616 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16617 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16618 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016619
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016620 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016621
16622 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16623 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16624 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016625 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016626
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016627 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16628 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16629
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016630 # capture groups and backreferences
16631 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016632 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016633 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16634
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016635capture-req(<id>)
16636 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16637 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16638
16639 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016640 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16641 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016642
16643capture-res(<id>)
16644 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16645 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16646
16647 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016648 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16649 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016650
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016651rtrim(<chars>)
16652 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16653 of the input sample.
16654
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016655sdbm([<avalanche>])
16656 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16657 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16658 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16659 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16660 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16661 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16662 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016663 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16664 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016665
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016666secure_memcmp(<var>)
16667 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16668 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16669 match.
16670
16671 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16672 performed in constant time.
16673
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016674 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016675 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16676
16677 Example :
16678
16679 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16680 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16681 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16682 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16683
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016684set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016685 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16686 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16687 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016688 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016689 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16690 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016691 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016692 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016694 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016695 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016696
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016697sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016698 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016699 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16700
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016701sha2([<bits>])
16702 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16703 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16704
16705 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16706 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16707
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016708 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016709 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16710
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016711srv_queue
16712 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16713 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16714 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16715 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16716 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16717
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016718strcmp(<var>)
16719 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16720 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16721 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16722 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16723 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16724 shorter).
16725
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016726 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16727 strings in constant time.
16728
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016729 Example :
16730
16731 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16732 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16733 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16734
16735
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016736sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016737 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16738 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016739 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016740 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16741 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016745 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016746 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16747 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016748 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016749 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016750
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016751table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16752 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16753 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16754 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16755 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16756 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16757 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16758
16759
16760table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16761 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16762 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16763 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16764 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16765 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16766 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16767
16768table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16769 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16770 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016771 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016772 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16773 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16774
16775table_conn_cur(<table>)
16776 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16777 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16778 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16779 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16780 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16781
16782table_conn_rate(<table>)
16783 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16784 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16785 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16786 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16787 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16788
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016789table_gpt0(<table>)
16790 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16791 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16792 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16793 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16794 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16795
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016796table_gpc0(<table>)
16797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16800 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16801 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16802
16803table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16804 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16805 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16806 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16807 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16808 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16809 sample fetch keyword.
16810
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016811table_gpc1(<table>)
16812 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16813 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16814 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16815 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16816 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16817
16818table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16819 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16820 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16821 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16822 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16823 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16824 sample fetch keyword.
16825
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016826table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016829 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016830 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16831 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16832
16833table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16834 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16835 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16836 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16837 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16838 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16839 keyword.
16840
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016841table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16845 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16846 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16847
16848table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16851 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16852 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16853 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16854 keyword.
16855
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016856table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016859 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016860 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16861 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16862
16863table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16864 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16865 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16866 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16867 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16868 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16869 keyword.
16870
16871table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16872 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16873 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016874 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016875 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16876 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16877 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16878 keyword.
16879
16880table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016884 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16885 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16886 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16887 keyword.
16888
16889table_server_id(<table>)
16890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16893 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16894 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16895 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16896
16897table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16898 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16899 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016900 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016901 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16902 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16903 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16904 keyword.
16905
16906table_sess_rate(<table>)
16907 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16908 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16909 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16910 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16911 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16912 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16913 keyword.
16914
16915table_trackers(<table>)
16916 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16917 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16918 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16919 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16920 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16921 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16922 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16923 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16924 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16925 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16926
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016927ub64dec
16928 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16929 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16930 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16931
16932 Example:
16933 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16934 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16935
16936ub64enc
16937 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16938
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016939upper
16940 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16941 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16942 type. The result is of type string.
16943
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016944url_dec([<in_form>])
16945 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16946 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16947 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16948 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16949 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16950 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016951
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016952url_enc([<enc_type>])
16953 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16954 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16955 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16956 optional argument is here for future changes.
16957
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016958ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016959 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016960 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16961 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16962 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016963 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16964 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16965 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16966 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016967 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016968 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16969 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016970
16971 Example:
16972 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16973 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16974
16975 message Point {
16976 int32 latitude = 1;
16977 int32 longitude = 2;
16978 }
16979
16980 message PPoint {
16981 Point point = 59;
16982 }
16983
16984 message Rectangle {
16985 // One corner of the rectangle.
16986 PPoint lo = 48;
16987 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16988 PPoint hi = 49;
16989 }
16990
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016991 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16992 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16993 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016994
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016995 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16996 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016997 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016998 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16999
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017000 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017001
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017002 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017003
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017004 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17005 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17006 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017007
17008 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17009 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17010 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17011
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017012 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17013 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17014 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017015
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017016
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017017unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017018 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17019 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17020 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17021 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17022 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17023 response),
17024 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17025 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17026 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17027 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17028
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017029utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17030 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17031 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17032 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17033 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17034 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17035 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17036
17037 Example :
17038
17039 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017040 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017041 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17042
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017043word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17044 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17045 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17046 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017047 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017048 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17049 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17050
17051 Example :
17052 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17053 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17054 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17055 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17056 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017057 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017058
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017059wt6([<avalanche>])
17060 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17061 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17062 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17063 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17064 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17065 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17066 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017067 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17068 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017069
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017070xor(<value>)
17071 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017072 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017073 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017074 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017075 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17077 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017078 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017079 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017081 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017082 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017083
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017084xxh3([<seed>])
17085 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17086 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17087 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17088 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17089 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17090 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17091 considered as cryptographically secure.
17092
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017093xxh32([<seed>])
17094 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17095 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17096 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17097 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17098 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17099 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17100 as cryptographically secure.
17101
17102xxh64([<seed>])
17103 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17104 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17105 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17106 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17107 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17108 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17109 as cryptographically secure.
17110
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017111
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171127.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017113--------------------------------------------
17114
17115A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17116not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17117"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17118The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17119
17120always_false : boolean
17121 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17122 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17123
17124always_true : boolean
17125 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17126 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17127
17128avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017129 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17131 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17132 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17133 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17134 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17135 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17136 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17137 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17138 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17139 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17140 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17141 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17142 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017144be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017145 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17146 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17147 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17148 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017149 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17150
17151be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17153 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17154 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17155 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17156 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017157 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17158 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017159
17160 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17161 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17162 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17166 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17167 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017168 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017169 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17170 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017171
17172 Example :
17173 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17174 backend dynamic
17175 mode http
17176 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17177 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017178
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017179bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017180 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17181 of the string.
17182
17183bool(<bool>) : bool
17184 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17185 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017187connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17188 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017189 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17191 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017192
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017193 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017194 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017195 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17196
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017197 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17198 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017199
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017200 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017201 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017202 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017203 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017204 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017206 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017207
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017208 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17209 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017210 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017211 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017212
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017213cpu_calls : integer
17214 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17215 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17216 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17217 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17218 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17219 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17220
17221cpu_ns_avg : integer
17222 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17223 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17224 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17225 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17226 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17227 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17228 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17229 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17230 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17231 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17232 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17233
17234cpu_ns_tot : integer
17235 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17236 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17237 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17238 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17239 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17240 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17241 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17242 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17243 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17244 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17245 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17246 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17247 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17248
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017249date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017250 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017251
17252 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17253 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17254 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017255 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17256
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017257 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17258 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17259 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17260 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17261 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17262
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017263 Example :
17264
17265 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17266 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017267
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017268 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17269 # millisecond granularity
17270 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17271
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017272date_us : integer
17273 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17274 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17275 from the same timeval structure.
17276
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017277distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17278 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17279 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17280 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17281 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017282 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017283 list of supported tokens.
17284
17285distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17286 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17287 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17288 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17289 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017290 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017291 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17292 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17293 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17294 supported tokens.
17295
17296 Example :
17297 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17298 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17299 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17300 # send large files to the big farm
17301 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17302
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017303env(<name>) : string
17304 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17305 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17306 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17307 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17308 certain way.
17309
17310 Examples :
17311 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17312 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17313
17314 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17315 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17318 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017319 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17320 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017321 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17322 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017323 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017324 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17325 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017326
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017327fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17328 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17329 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17330 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017332fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17333 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17334 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17335 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17336 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17337 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17338 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17339 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17340 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017341
17342 Example :
17343 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17344 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17345 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17346 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17347 frontend mail
17348 bind :25
17349 mode tcp
17350 maxconn 100
17351 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17352 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17353 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17354 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017355
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017356hostname : string
17357 Returns the system hostname.
17358
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017359int(<integer>) : signed integer
17360 Returns a signed integer.
17361
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017362ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17363 Returns an ipv4.
17364
17365ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17366 Returns an ipv6.
17367
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017368lat_ns_avg : integer
17369 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17370 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17371 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17372 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17373 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17374 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17375 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17376 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17377 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017378 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17379 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17380 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17381 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17382 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17383 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017384
17385lat_ns_tot : integer
17386 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17387 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17388 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17389 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17390 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17391 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17392 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17393 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17394 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017395 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17396 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17397 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17398 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17399 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017400 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17401 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17402 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17403 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17404 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17405 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17406
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017407meth(<method>) : method
17408 Returns a method.
17409
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017410nbproc : integer
17411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17412 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17413 and debugging purposes.
17414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017415nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17416 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17417 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17418 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017419 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17420 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17421 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017422
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017423prio_class : integer
17424 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17425 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17426 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17427
17428prio_offset : integer
17429 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17430 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17431 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17432 set-priority-offset".
17433
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017434proc : integer
17435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17436 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17437 debugging purposes.
17438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017440 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17441 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17442 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017443 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17444 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17445 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17446 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17447 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17448
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017449rand([<range>]) : integer
17450 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17451 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17452 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17453 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17454 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017456srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17457 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17458 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17459 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17460 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17461 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017462 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17463 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17464
17465srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17466 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17467 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17468 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17469 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17470 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17471 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17472 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17473
17474 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17475 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476
17477srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17478 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17479 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17480 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017481 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17483 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17484 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17485
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017486srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17487 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17488 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17489 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17490 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17491 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17492 fetch methods.
17493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017494srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17495 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17496 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017497 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017498 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17499 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017500 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017501 overloading servers).
17502
17503 Example :
17504 # Redirect to a separate back
17505 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17506 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17507 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17508
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017509srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017510 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17511 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17512 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17513
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017514srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017515 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17516 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17517 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17518
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017519srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017520 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17521 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17522 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17523
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017524stopping : boolean
17525 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17526 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17527 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17528
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017529str(<string>) : string
17530 Returns a string.
17531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17533 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17534 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17535
17536table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17537 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17538 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17539 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17540
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017541thread : integer
17542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17543 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17544 and debugging purposes.
17545
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017546uuid([<version>]) : string
17547 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17548 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17549 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17550
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017551var(<var-name>) : undefined
17552 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017553 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17554 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017555 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017556 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17557 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017558 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017559 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17560 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017561 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017562 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017563
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175647.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017565----------------------------------
17566
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017567The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017568closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17569methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17570sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17571TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017572the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17573counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017574"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17575used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17576can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17577Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17578table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17579tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17580currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017582bc_dst : ip
17583 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17584 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17585 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17586 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17587
17588bc_dst_port : integer
17589 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017590 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017591
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017592bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017593 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17594 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17595 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17596
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017597bc_src : ip
17598 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017599 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017600 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17601 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17602
17603bc_src_port : integer
17604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017605 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017607be_id : integer
17608 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017609 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17610 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017611
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017612be_name : string
17613 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017614 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17615 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017616
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017617be_server_timeout : integer
17618 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17619 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17620 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17621
17622be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17623 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17624 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17625 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17626
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017627cur_server_timeout : integer
17628 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17629 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17630 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17631
17632cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17633 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17634 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17635 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017637dst : ip
17638 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17639 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17640 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17641 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017642 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17643 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17644 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17645 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17646 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17647 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017648
17649dst_conn : integer
17650 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17651 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17652 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17653 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17654 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17655 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17656 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17657 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017658
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017659dst_is_local : boolean
17660 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17661 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17662 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17663 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017664 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017665 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17666 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17667 it only once per connection.
17668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017669dst_port : integer
17670 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17671 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17672 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17673 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17674 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17675 an HTTP header.
17676
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017677fc_http_major : integer
17678 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17679 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17680 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17681
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017682fc_pp_authority : string
17683 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17684 if any.
17685
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017686fc_pp_unique_id : string
17687 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17688 if any.
17689
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017690fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17691 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17692 header.
17693
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017694fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17695 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17696 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17697 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17698 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17699 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17700 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17701
17702fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17703 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17704 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17705 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17706 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17707 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17708 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17709
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017710fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017711 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17712 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17713 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17714 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17715
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017716fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017717 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17718 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17719 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17720 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17721
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017722fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017723 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17724 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17725 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17726 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17727
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017728fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017729 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17730 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17731 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17732 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17733
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017734fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017735 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17736 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17737 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17738 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17739
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017740fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017741 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17742 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17743 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17744 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17745
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017746fe_defbe : string
17747 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17748 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017750fe_id : integer
17751 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017752 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017753 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17754
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017755fe_name : string
17756 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17757 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17758 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17759
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017760fe_client_timeout : integer
17761 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17762 current frontend.
17763
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017764sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017765sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17766sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17767sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017768 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17769 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17770 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17771
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017772sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017773sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17774sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17775sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017776 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17777 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17778 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17779
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017780sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017781sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17782sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17783sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017784 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17785 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017786 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17787 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17788 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017789
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017790 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017791 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17792 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017793 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17794 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17795 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017796 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17797 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17798
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017799sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17800sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17801sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17802sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17803 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17804 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17805 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17806 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17807 when a first ACL was verified.
17808
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017809sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017810sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17811sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17812sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017813 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017814 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017816sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017817sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17818sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17819sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017820 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17821 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17822 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17823
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017824sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017825sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17826sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17827sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017828 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17829 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17830 See also src_conn_rate.
17831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017832sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017833sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17834sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17835sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017836 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017837 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017838
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017839sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17840sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17841sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17842sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17843 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17844 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17845
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017846sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17847sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17848sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17849sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17850 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17851 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017853sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017854sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17855sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17856sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017857 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17858 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17859 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017860 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17861 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17862 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017863
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017864sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17865sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17866sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17867sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17868 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17869 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17870 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17871 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17872 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17873 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17874
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017875sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017876sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17877sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17878sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017879 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017880 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17881 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017883sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017884sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17885sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17886sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017887 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17888 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17889 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17890 src_http_err_rate.
17891
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017892sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17893sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17894sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17895sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17896 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17897 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17898 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17899
17900sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17901sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17902sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17903sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17904 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17905 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17906 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17907 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17908
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017909sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017910sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17911sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17912sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017913 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017914 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17915 src_http_req_cnt.
17916
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017917sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017918sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17919sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17920sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017921 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17922 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17923 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17924 src_http_req_rate.
17925
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017926sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017927sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17928sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17929sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017930 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017931 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17932 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17933 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17934 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017935
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017936 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017937 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17938 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017939 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17940
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017941sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17942sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17943sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17944sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17945 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17946 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17947 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17948 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17949 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17950
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017951sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017952sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17953sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17954sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017955 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17956 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17957 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017959sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017960sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17961sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17962sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017963 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17964 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17965 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017967sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017968sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17969sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17970sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017971 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017972 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17973 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17974 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017975 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017976 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17977
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017978sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017979sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17980sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17981sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017982 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17983 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17984 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17985 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17986 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017987 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017988
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017989sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017990sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17991sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17992sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017993 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17994 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17995 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17996
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017997sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017998sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17999sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18000sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018001 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18002 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018003 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018004 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18005 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018006 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18007 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18008 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018010so_id : integer
18011 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18012 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18013 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018014
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018015so_name : string
18016 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18017 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18018 strings instead of integers.
18019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018020src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018021 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18023 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18024 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018025 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18026 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18027 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018028 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18029 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18030 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18031 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18032 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18033 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18034 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018035
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018036 Example:
18037 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18038 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018040src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18041 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18042 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18043 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018044 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018046src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18047 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18048 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018049 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018050 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18053 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18054 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18055 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18056 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18057 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18058 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018059
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018060 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018061 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18062 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18063 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18064 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018065 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018066 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18067 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18068
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018069src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18070 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18071 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18072 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18073 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18074 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18075 was verified.
18076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018077src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018078 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018079 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018080 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018081 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018084 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018085 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18086 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018087 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018089src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18090 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18091 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18092 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018093 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018095src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018096 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018097 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018098 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018099 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018100
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018101src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18102 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18103 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18104 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18105 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18106
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018107src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18108 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18109 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18110 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18111 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018113src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018114 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018115 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018116 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18117 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018118 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18119 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18120 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018121
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018122src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18123 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18124 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18125 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18126 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18127 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18128 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18129 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018131src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018132 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018133 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018134 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018135 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018136 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018138src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18139 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18140 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18141 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18142 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018143 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018144
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018145src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18146 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18147 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018148 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018149 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18150 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18151
18152src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18153 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18154 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18155 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18156 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18157 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18158 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018160src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018161 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018162 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18163 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018164 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18167 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18168 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18169 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018170 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018171 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018173src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18174 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18175 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18176 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018177 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018178 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18179 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018180
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018181 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018182 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018183 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018184 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018185
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018186src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18187 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18188 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18189 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18190 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18191 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18192 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18193
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018194src_is_local : boolean
18195 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18196 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18197 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18198 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018199 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018200 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18201 once per connection.
18202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018203src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018204 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18205 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18206 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18207 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18208 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018211 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18212 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18213 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18214 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18215 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217src_port : integer
18218 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18219 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18220 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18221 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018224 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018225 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18226 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18227 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018228 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18231 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18232 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18233 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18234 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018235 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018237src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18238 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18239 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18240 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18241 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18242 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18243 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18244 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18245 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018246
18247 Example :
18248 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18249 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18250 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18251 listen ssh
18252 bind :22
18253 mode tcp
18254 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018255 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018256 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018257 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018259srv_id : integer
18260 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18261 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018262 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018263
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018264srv_name : string
18265 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18266 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018267 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018268
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182697.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018271
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018272The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18274when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18275usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018276future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018277
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001827851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18279 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18280 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18281 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18282 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18283 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18284
18285 Example :
18286 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18287 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18288 # the request.
18289 frontend http-in
18290 bind *:8081
18291 default_backend servers
18292 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18293 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18294
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018295ssl_bc : boolean
18296 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18297 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018298 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18299 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018300
18301ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18302 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018303 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18304 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018305
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018306ssl_bc_alpn : string
18307 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18308 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018309 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018310 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18311 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18312 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18313 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18314 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018315 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18316 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018317
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018318ssl_bc_cipher : string
18319 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018320 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18321 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018322
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018323ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18324 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18325 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18326 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018327 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018328
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018329ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18330 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18331 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018332 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18333 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018334
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018335ssl_bc_npn : string
18336 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18337 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018338 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018339 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18340 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18341 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18342 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018343 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18344 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018345
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018346ssl_bc_protocol : string
18347 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018348 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18349 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018350
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018351ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018352 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018353 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018354 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18355 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018356
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018357ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18358 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18359 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18360 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018361 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018362
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018363ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18364 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18365 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018366 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18367 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018368
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018369ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18370 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18371 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18372 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018373 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018374
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018375ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18376 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018377 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18378 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018380ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18381 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18382 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18383 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18384 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18385 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018387ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18388 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18389 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18390 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18391 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018392
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018393ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018394 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18395 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18396 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018397 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018398 does not support resumed sessions.
18399
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018400ssl_c_der : binary
18401 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18402 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18403 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018405ssl_c_err : integer
18406 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18407 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18408 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18409 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18410 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018411
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018412ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018413 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18414 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18415 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18416 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18417 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18418 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18419 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18420 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018421 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18422 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18423 LDAP v3.
18424 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18425 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018427ssl_c_key_alg : string
18428 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18429 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18430 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432ssl_c_notafter : string
18433 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18434 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18435 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437ssl_c_notbefore : string
18438 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18439 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18440 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018441
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018442ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018443 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18444 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18445 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18446 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18447 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18448 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18449 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18450 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018451 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18452 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18453 LDAP v3.
18454 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18455 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457ssl_c_serial : binary
18458 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18459 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18460 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18463 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18464 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18465 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018466 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18467 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18468
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018469 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018470 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18473 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18474 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18475 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018477ssl_c_used : boolean
18478 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18479 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481ssl_c_verify : integer
18482 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18483 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18484 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18485 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018487ssl_c_version : integer
18488 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18489 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018490
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018491ssl_f_der : binary
18492 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18493 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18494 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18495
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018496ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18498 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18499 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18500 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018501 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18503 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18504 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018505 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18506 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18507 LDAP v3.
18508 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18509 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511ssl_f_key_alg : string
18512 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18513 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18514 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018516ssl_f_notafter : string
18517 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18518 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18519 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018521ssl_f_notbefore : string
18522 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18523 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18524 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018525
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018526ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018527 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18528 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18529 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18530 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18531 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18532 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18533 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18534 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018535 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18536 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18537 LDAP v3.
18538 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18539 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018541ssl_f_serial : binary
18542 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18543 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18544 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018545
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018546ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18547 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18548 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18549 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018551ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18552 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18553 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18554 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018556ssl_f_version : integer
18557 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18558 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18559
18560ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018561 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18562 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18563 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565 Example :
18566 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18567 listen http-https
18568 bind :80
18569 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18570 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18571
18572ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18573 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18574 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18575
18576ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018577 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018578 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018579 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018580 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18581 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18582 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18583 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18584 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18585 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018587ssl_fc_cipher : string
18588 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18589 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018590
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018591ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18592 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18593 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018594 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018595
18596ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18597 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18598 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018599 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018600
18601ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18602 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18603 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18604 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018605 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018606 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018607
18608ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18609 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18610 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018611 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018612
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018613ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18614 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18615 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18616 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18617
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018618ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18619 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18620 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18621 transport layer.
18622 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18623 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18624 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18625 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18626
18627ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18628 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18629 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18630 transport layer.
18631 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18632 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18633 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18634 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18635
18636ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18637 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18638 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18639 transport layer.
18640 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18641 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18642 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18643 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18644
18645ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18646 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18647 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18648 transport layer.
18649 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18650 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18651 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18652 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18653
18654ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18655 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18656 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18657 transport layer.
18658 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18659 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18660 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18661 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018663ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018664 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18665 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018666 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18667 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18668 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18669 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018670
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018671ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18672 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18673 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18674 wait until the handshake happened.
18675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018676ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18677 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018678 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18679 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018680 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018681 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018682
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018683ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018684 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018685 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18686 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018688ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018689 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018690 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018691 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18692 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18693 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18694 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18695 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18696 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018698ssl_fc_protocol : string
18699 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18700 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018701
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018702ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018703 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018704 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18705 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018706
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018707ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18708 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18709 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18710 transport layer.
18711 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18712 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18713 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18714 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18715
18716ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18717 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18718 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18719 transport layer.
18720 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18721 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18722 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18723 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18724
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018725ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18726 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18727 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18728 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018730ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18731 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18732 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18733 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18734 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018735
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018736ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18737 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18738 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18739 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18740 BoringSSL.
18741
18742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018743ssl_fc_sni : string
18744 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18745 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018746 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018747 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18748 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18749
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018750 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018751 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018752 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018753 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018754 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018756 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18758 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018760ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18761 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18762 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018763
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018764ssl_s_der : binary
18765 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18766 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18767 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18768
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018769ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18770 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18771 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18772 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018773 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018774 does not support resumed sessions.
18775
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018776ssl_s_key_alg : string
18777 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18778 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18779 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18780
18781ssl_s_notafter : string
18782 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18783 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18784 transport layer.
18785
18786ssl_s_notbefore : string
18787 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18788 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18789 transport layer.
18790
18791ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18792 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18793 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18794 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18795 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18796 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18797 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018798 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18799 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018800 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18801 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18802 LDAP v3.
18803 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18804 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18805
18806ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18807 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18808 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18809 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18810 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18811 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18812 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018813 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18814 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018815 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18816 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18817 LDAP v3.
18818 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18819 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18820
18821ssl_s_serial : binary
18822 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18823 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18824 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18825
18826ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18827 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18828 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18829 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18830
18831ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18832 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18833 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18834 layer.
18835
18836ssl_s_version : integer
18837 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18838 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018839
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188407.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18844sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18845only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18846For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18847be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18848can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18849sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18850for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18851content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018852
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018853Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18854 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018855 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018856 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18857 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18858 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18859 sample expression). So be careful.
18860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018861payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018862 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18864 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018866payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18867 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018868 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018869 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871req.len : integer
18872req_len : integer (deprecated)
18873 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18874 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18875 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18876 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18877 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018878 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018879 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18880 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018882req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18883 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018884 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18885 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18886 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18887 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889 ACL alternatives :
18890 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018892req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18893 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18894 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18895 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18896 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018898 ACL alternatives :
18899 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018903req.proto_http : boolean
18904req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18905 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18906 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18907 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18908 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18909 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18910 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18911 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018913 Example:
18914 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18915 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18916 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018917 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018919req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18920rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18921 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18922 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18923 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18924 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18925 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18926 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18927 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018929 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18930 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18931 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18932 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18933 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18934 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018936 ACL derivatives :
18937 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018939 Example :
18940 listen tse-farm
18941 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18942 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18943 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18944 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18945 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18946 persist rdp-cookie
18947 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18948 # This is only useful makes sense if
18949 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18950 stick-table type string size 204800
18951 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18952 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18953 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018955 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18956 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018958req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18959rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18960 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18961 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18962 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18963 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018965 ACL derivatives :
18966 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018967
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018968req.ssl_alpn : string
18969 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18970 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18971 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18972 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18973 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18974 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018975 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018976
18977 Examples :
18978 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18979 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18980 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018981 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018982 default_backend bk_default
18983
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018984req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18985 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18986 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018987 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18988 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18989 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18990 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18991 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018993req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18994req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18995 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18996 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18997 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18998 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18999 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19000 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19001 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019003req.ssl_sni : string
19004req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19005 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19006 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19007 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19008 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19009 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019010 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19011 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19012 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19013 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19014 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19015 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19016 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19017 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19018 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019020 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019021 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019023 Examples :
19024 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19025 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19026 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019027 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019028 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019029
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019030req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19031 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19032 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19033 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19034 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19035 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19036 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19037 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19038 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19039 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019041req.ssl_ver : integer
19042req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19043 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19044 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19045 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19046 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19047 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19048 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19049 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019050 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019051 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053 ACL derivatives :
19054 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019055
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019056res.len : integer
19057 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19058 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19059 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19060 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19061 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019062 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019063 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019064 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019066res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19067 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019068 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019069 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019070 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019071 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019073res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19074 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19075 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19076 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019077 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19078 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019081
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019082res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19083rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19084 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19085 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19086 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19087 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19088 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19089 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19090 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019092wait_end : boolean
19093 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19094 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019095 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019096 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19097 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019098 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019099 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19100 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019102 Examples :
19103 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19104 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19105 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019107 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19108 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19109 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19110 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19111 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19112 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19113 tcp-request content reject
19114
19115
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200191167.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019117--------------------------------------
19118
19119It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19120This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19121data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19122its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19123HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19124content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19125to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19126more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19127response are indexed.
19128
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019129Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19130 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19131 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19132 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19133 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19134 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19135 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019137base : string
19138 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19139 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19140 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19141 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19142 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19143 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19144 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19145 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19146
19147 ACL derivatives :
19148 base : exact string match
19149 base_beg : prefix match
19150 base_dir : subdir match
19151 base_dom : domain match
19152 base_end : suffix match
19153 base_len : length match
19154 base_reg : regex match
19155 base_sub : substring match
19156
19157base32 : integer
19158 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19159 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19160 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019161 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19162 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19163 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164
19165base32+src : binary
19166 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19167 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19168 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19169 per-URL counters.
19170
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019171baseq : string
19172 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19173 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19174 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19175 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19176
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019177capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19178 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19179 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19180 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19181
19182capture.req.method : string
19183 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19184 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19185 because it's allocated.
19186
19187capture.req.uri : string
19188 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19189 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19190 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19191 allocated.
19192
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019193capture.req.ver : string
19194 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19195 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19196 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19197
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019198capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19199 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19200 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19201 The first entry is an index of 0.
19202 See also: "capture response header"
19203
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019204capture.res.ver : string
19205 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19206 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19207 persistent flag.
19208
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019209req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019210 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19211 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19212 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019213
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019214req.body_param([<name>) : string
19215 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19216 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19217 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19218 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19219 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19220 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19221 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19222 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19223 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19224 given.
19225
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019226req.body_len : integer
19227 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19228 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019229 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19230 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019231
19232req.body_size : integer
19233 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019234 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19235 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019237req.cook([<name>]) : string
19238cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19239 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19240 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19241 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19242 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19243 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19244 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19245 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19246 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19247
19248 ACL derivatives :
19249 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19250 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19251 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19252 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19253 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19254 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19255 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19256 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019258req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19259cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19260 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19261 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019263req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19264cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19265 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19266 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19267 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19268 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019270cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19271 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19272 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19273 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19274 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019275 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019276 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19277 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19278 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19279 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019281hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19282 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19283 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19284 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19285 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019286 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019288req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019289 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19290 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19291 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19292 with headers such as User-Agent.
19293
19294 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19295 found.
19296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19298 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19299 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019300 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019302req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19303 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19304 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019305 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19306 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019308req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019309 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19310 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19311 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19312 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19313 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19314 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19315 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19316
19317 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19318 found.
19319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19321 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19322 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019323 with -1 being the last one.
19324
19325 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19326 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019328 ACL derivatives :
19329 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19330 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19331 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19332 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19333 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19334 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19335 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19336 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19337
19338req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19339hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19340 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19341 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019342 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19343 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19344 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19345
19346 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19347 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19348 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19349
19350 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019351
19352req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19353hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19354 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19355 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19356 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019357 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19358 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19359 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19360 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19361 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019362
19363 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19364
19365 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019366
19367req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19368hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19369 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19370 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19371 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019372
19373 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19374
19375 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019376
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019377req.hdrs : string
19378 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19379 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19380 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19381 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19382
19383req.hdrs_bin : binary
19384 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19385 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19386 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19387 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19388 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19389 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19390
19391 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019392
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019393 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19394 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19397 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19398 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19399 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19400 basic auth is supported.
19401
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019402http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19403 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19404 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19405 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19406 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019407 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19408 basic auth is supported.
19409
19410 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019411 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19412 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19413 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19414 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019415
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019416http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019417 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19418 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19419 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019420
19421http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019422 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19423 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19424 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019425
19426http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019427 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19428 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19429 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019431http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019432 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19433 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019434 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19435 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437method : integer + string
19438 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19439 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19440 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19441 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19442 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19443 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19444 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019446 ACL derivatives :
19447 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019449 Example :
19450 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19451 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19452 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019454path : string
19455 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19456 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19457 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19458 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19459 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019460 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019461 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019463 ACL derivatives :
19464 path : exact string match
19465 path_beg : prefix match
19466 path_dir : subdir match
19467 path_dom : domain match
19468 path_end : suffix match
19469 path_len : length match
19470 path_reg : regex match
19471 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019472
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019473pathq : string
19474 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19475 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19476 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19477 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19478 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19479 result in both cases.
19480
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019481query : string
19482 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19483 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19484 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19485 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019486 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019487 which stops before the question mark.
19488
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019489req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19490 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19491 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19492 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19493 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019495req.ver : string
19496req_ver : string (deprecated)
19497 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19498 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19499 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019501 ACL derivatives :
19502 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019503
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019504res.body : binary
19505 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19506 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019507 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19508
19509 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019510
19511res.body_len : integer
19512 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19513 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019514 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19515
19516 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019517
19518res.body_size : integer
19519 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19520 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19521 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19522 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019523 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19524
19525 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019526
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019527res.cache_hit : boolean
19528 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19529 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19530
19531res.cache_name : string
19532 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19533 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19534 empty string.
19535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019536res.comp : boolean
19537 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19538 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19539 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019541res.comp_algo : string
19542 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19543 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19544 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019546res.cook([<name>]) : string
19547scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19548 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19549 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019550 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19551
19552 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019554 ACL derivatives :
19555 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019557res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19558scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19559 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19560 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019561 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19562
19563 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019565res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19566scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19567 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19568 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019569 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19570
19571 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019573res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019574 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19575 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19576
19577 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19578 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19579
19580 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19581
19582 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019585 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19586 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19587
19588 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19589 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19590
19591 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19594shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019595 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19596 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19597
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019598 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019599 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19600
19601 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019603 ACL derivatives :
19604 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19605 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19606 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19607 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19608 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19609 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19610 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19611 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19612
19613res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19614shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019615 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19616 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19617
19618 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019619 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019620
19621 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019623res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19624shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019625 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19626 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19627
19628 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19629
19630 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019631
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019632res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19633 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19634 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19635 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019636 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19637
19638 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019640res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19641shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019642 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19643 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19644
19645 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19646
19647 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019648
19649res.hdrs : string
19650 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19651 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19652 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019653 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19654
19655 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019656
19657res.hdrs_bin : binary
19658 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19659 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19660 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19661 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19662 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19663 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19664 (length of 0 for both).
19665
19666 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19667
19668 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19669 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019671res.ver : string
19672resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19673 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019674 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19675
19676 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019678 ACL derivatives :
19679 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019681set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19682 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19683 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019684 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019685 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019687 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19688 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690status : integer
19691 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19692 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019693 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19694
19695 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019696
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019697unique-id : string
19698 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19699 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19700 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19701 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19702 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19703 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019705url : string
19706 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19707 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19708 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19709 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19710 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19711 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19712 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019714 ACL derivatives :
19715 url : exact string match
19716 url_beg : prefix match
19717 url_dir : subdir match
19718 url_dom : domain match
19719 url_end : suffix match
19720 url_len : length match
19721 url_reg : regex match
19722 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019724url_ip : ip
19725 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19726 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19727 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19728 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19729 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19730 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19731 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019733url_port : integer
19734 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19735 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19736 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19737 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019738
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019739urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19740url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019741 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19742 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019743 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19744 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19745 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19746 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019747 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19748 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019749 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19750 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019752 ACL derivatives :
19753 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19754 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19755 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19756 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19757 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19758 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19759 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19760 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019761
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019763 Example :
19764 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19765 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19766 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19767 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019768
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019769urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019770 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19771 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19772 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019773
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019774url32 : integer
19775 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19776 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19777 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19778 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19779 is an unsigned integer.
19780
19781url32+src : binary
19782 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19783 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19784 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19785
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019786
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197877.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019788---------------------------------------
19789
19790This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19791used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19792purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19793There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19794or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19795any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19796for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19797
19798internal.htx.data : integer
19799 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19800 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19801
19802internal.htx.free : integer
19803 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19804 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19805
19806internal.htx.free_data : integer
19807 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19808 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19809
19810internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019811 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19812 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19813 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019814
19815internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19816 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19817 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19818
19819internal.htx.size : integer
19820 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19821 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19822
19823internal.htx.used : integer
19824 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19825 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19826 direction.
19827
19828internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19829 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19830 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19831 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19832 of the special value :
19833 * head : The oldest inserted block
19834 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019835 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019836
19837internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19838 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19839 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19840 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19841 integer or one of the special value :
19842 * head : The oldest inserted block
19843 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019844 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019845
19846internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19847 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19848 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19849 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19850 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19851
19852 * head : The oldest inserted block
19853 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019854 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019855
19856internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19857 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19858 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19859 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19860 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19861
19862 * head : The oldest inserted block
19863 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019864 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019865
19866internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19867 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19868 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19869 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19870 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19871
19872 * head : The oldest inserted block
19873 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019874 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019875
19876internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19877 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19878 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19879 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19880 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19881
19882 * head : The oldest inserted block
19883 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019884 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019885
19886internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19887 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19888 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19889 it returns false.
19890
19891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019893---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019895Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19896every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019897order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019899ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019900---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19901FALSE always_false never match
19902HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19903HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19904HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019905HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019906HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19907HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19908HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19909HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19910LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19911METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19912METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19913METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19914METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19915METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19916METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19917METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19918METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19919RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19920REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19921TRUE always_true always match
19922WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19923---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019924
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199268. Logging
19927----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019929One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19930provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19931very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19932provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19933state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019934to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019935headers.
19936
19937In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19938about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19939send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19940
19941 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19942 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19943 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19944 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19945 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019946 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019947 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019948
19949The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19950allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19951as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19952while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19953real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19954delay.
19955
19956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199578.1. Log levels
19958---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019959
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019960TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019961source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019962HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19963in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19964track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19965syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19966about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019967
19968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199698.2. Log formats
19970----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019972HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019973and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19974slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19975options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019976
19977 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19978 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19979 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19980 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19981 extents.
19982
19983 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19984 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19985 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19986 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19987 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19988
19989 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19990 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19991 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19992 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19993 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19994
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019995 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19996 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19997 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19998 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19999
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020000 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20001
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020002Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20003specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20004field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20005servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20006always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20007identifier.
20008
20009Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20010 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20011 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20012 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20013 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20014
20015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200168.2.1. Default log format
20017-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020018
20019This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20020as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20021format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20022
20023 Example :
20024 listen www
20025 mode http
20026 log global
20027 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20028
20029 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20030 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20031 (www/HTTP)
20032
20033 Field Format Extract from the example above
20034 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20035 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20036 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20037 4 'to' to
20038 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20039 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20040
20041Detailed fields description :
20042 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20043 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20044 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20045 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20046 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20047 and processed the connection.
20048 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20049
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020050In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20051"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20052connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20053
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020054It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20055will eventually disappear.
20056
20057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200588.2.2. TCP log format
20059---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020060
20061The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20062is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20063information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20064counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20065emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20066environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20067the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20068sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020069specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20070not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20071fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20072marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020073
20074 Example :
20075 frontend fnt
20076 mode tcp
20077 option tcplog
20078 log global
20079 default_backend bck
20080
20081 backend bck
20082 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20083
20084 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20085 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20086 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20087
20088 Field Format Extract from the example above
20089 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20090 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20091 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20092 4 frontend_name fnt
20093 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20094 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20095 7 bytes_read* 212
20096 8 termination_state --
20097 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20098 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20099
20100Detailed fields description :
20101 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020102 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020103 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20104 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020105 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020106 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020107 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020108
20109 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020110 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20111 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20112 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020114 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020115 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20116 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020117 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20118 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20119 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20120 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020121
20122 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20123 and processed the connection.
20124
20125 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20126 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20127 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20128 applications.
20129
20130 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20131 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20132 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20133 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20134 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20135
20136 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20137 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20138 See "Timers" below for more details.
20139
20140 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20141 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20142 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20143 "Timers" below for more details.
20144
20145 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020146 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020147 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20148 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20149 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20150 details.
20151
20152 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20153 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20154 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20155 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20156 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20157
20158 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20159 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20160 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20161 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20162 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20163 for more details.
20164
20165 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020166 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020167 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20168 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20169 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020170 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020171
20172 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20173 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20174 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20175 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20176 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20177 caused by a denial of service attack.
20178
20179 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20180 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20181 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20182 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20183 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20184 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20185 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20186 denial of service attack.
20187
20188 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20189 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20190 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20191 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20192 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20193 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20194 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20195 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20196 be processed than on other servers.
20197
20198 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20199 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20200 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20201 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020202 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020203 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20204 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20205 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20206 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20207 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20208 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20209 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20210 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20211
20212 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20213 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20214 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20215 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20216 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20217 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020218 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20220
20221 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20222 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20223 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20224 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20225 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20226 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020227 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20229 occurs.
20230
20231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202328.2.3. HTTP log format
20233----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020234
20235The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20236is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20237the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20238are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20239emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20240generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20241"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20242which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020243frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20244is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020245
20246Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20247slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20248with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20249
20250 Example :
20251 frontend http-in
20252 mode http
20253 option httplog
20254 log global
20255 default_backend bck
20256
20257 backend static
20258 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20259
20260 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20261 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20262 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020263 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020264
20265 Field Format Extract from the example above
20266 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20267 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020268 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020269 4 frontend_name http-in
20270 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020271 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272 7 status_code 200
20273 8 bytes_read* 2750
20274 9 captured_request_cookie -
20275 10 captured_response_cookie -
20276 11 termination_state ----
20277 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20278 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20279 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20280 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20281 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020282
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020283Detailed fields description :
20284 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020285 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020286 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20287 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020288 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020289 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020290 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020291
20292 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020293 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20294 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20295 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020296
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020297 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020298 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020299
20300 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20301 and processed the connection.
20302
20303 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20304 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20305 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20306
20307 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20308 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20309 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20310 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20311 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20312 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20313
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020314 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20315 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20316 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020317 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020318 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20319 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020320 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020321 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020322
20323 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20324 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020325 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020326
20327 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20328 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020329 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20330 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020331
20332 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20333 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20334 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20335 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20336 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020337 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20338 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020339
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020340 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020341 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20342 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20343 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20344 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20345 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20346 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020347 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020348
20349 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020350 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20351 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020352
20353 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20354 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020355 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020356 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20357 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20358 overflowing.
20359
20360 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20361 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20362 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20363 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20364 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20365 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20366 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20367 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20368
20369 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20370 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20371 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20372 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20373 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20374 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20375 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20376 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20377
20378 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20379 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20380 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20381 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20382 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20383 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20384 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20385
20386 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020387 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020388 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20389 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20390 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020391 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020392 system.
20393
20394 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20395 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20396 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20397 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20398 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20399 caused by a denial of service attack.
20400
20401 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20402 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20403 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20404 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20405 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20406 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20407 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20408 denial of service attack.
20409
20410 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20411 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20412 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20413 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20414 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20415 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20416 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20417 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20418 processed than on other servers.
20419
20420 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20421 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20422 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20423 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020424 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020425 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20426 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20427 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20428 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20429 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20430 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20431 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20432 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20433
20434 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20435 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20436 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20437 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20438 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20439 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020440 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020441 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20442
20443 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20444 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20445 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20446 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20447 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20448 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020449 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020450 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20451 occurs.
20452
20453 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20454 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20455 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20456 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20457 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20458 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20459 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20460 cookies" below for more details.
20461
20462 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20463 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20464 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20465 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20466 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20467 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20468 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20469 and cookies" below for more details.
20470
20471 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20472 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20473 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20474 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20475 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20476 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20477 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20478 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20479
20480
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200204818.2.4. Custom log format
20482------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020483
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020484The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020485mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020487HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020488Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20489separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20490prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20491
20492Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20493variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020494("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020495
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020496If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020497as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020498less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20499the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20500
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020501Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20502"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20503delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20504preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020505
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020506Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20507'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20508https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20509such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20510
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020511Flags are :
20512 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020513 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020514 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20515 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020516
20517 Example:
20518
20519 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20520 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20521
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020522 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20523
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020524At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20525
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020526 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20527 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020528
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020529the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020530
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020531 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20532 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20533 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020534
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020535and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20536
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020537 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20538 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020539
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020540Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20541
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020542 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020543 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020544 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20545 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20546 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020547 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20548 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20549 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020550 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020551 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020552 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020553 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020554 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020555 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20556 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020557 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020558 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020559 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020560 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020561 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020562 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020563 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020564 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20565 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20566 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20567 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20568 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020569 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020570 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020571 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020572 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020573 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020574 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20575 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020576 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20577 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20578 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020579 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020580 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20581 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020582 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020583 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20584 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20585 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020586 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020587 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020588 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20589 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20590 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20591 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020592 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020593 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020594 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020595 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020596 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020597 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020598 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20599 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20600 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020601 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020602 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20603 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020604 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020605 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20606 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020607 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020608 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020609 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020610 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020611
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020612 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020613
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020614
206158.2.5. Error log format
20616-----------------------
20617
20618When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020619protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020620By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20621"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020622will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020623logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20624
20625The format looks like this :
20626
20627 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20628 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20629 Connection error during SSL handshake
20630
20631 Field Format Extract from the example above
20632 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20633 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20634 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20635 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20636 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20637
20638These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20639failures.
20640
20641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206428.3. Advanced logging options
20643-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020644
20645Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20646just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20647options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20648for more information about their usage.
20649
20650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206518.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20652------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020653
20654It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020655HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020656commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20657monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20658ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20659
20660 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20661 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20662 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20663 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20664
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020665 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20666 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020667
20668 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20669 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20670 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20671
20672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206738.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20674----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020675
20676The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20677what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20678or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020679"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020680just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20681log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20682after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20683is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20684with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20685with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20686
20687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206888.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20689------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020690
20691Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20692for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20693"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20694retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20695raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20696a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20697file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20698you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20699"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20700
20701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207028.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20703--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020704
20705Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20706multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20707them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20708"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20709logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20710error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20711and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20712too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20713useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20714alternative.
20715
20716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207178.4. Timing events
20718------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020719
20720Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20721reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20722the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20723frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020724mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20725addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20726
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020727Timings events in HTTP mode:
20728
20729 first request 2nd request
20730 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20731 t tr t tr ...
20732 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20733 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20734 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20735 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020736 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020737 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20738
20739Timings events in TCP mode:
20740
20741 TCP session
20742 |<----------------->|
20743 t t
20744 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20745 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20746 |<------ Tt ------->|
20747
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020748 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020749 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020750 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20751 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20752 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020753 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020754 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20755 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20756 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20757 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020758
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020759 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20760 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20761 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020762 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20763 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20764 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20765 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20766 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20767 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020768
20769 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20770 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20771 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20772 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20773 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20774 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20775 request typed by hand during a test.
20776
20777 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20778 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020779 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020780 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20781 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20782 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20783 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020784
20785 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20786 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20787 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20788 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20789 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20790
20791 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20792 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20793 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20794 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20795 connection never established.
20796
20797 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20798 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20799 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20800 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20801 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20802 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20803 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20804 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20805 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20806 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20807 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20808
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020809 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20810 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20811 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20812 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20813 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20814 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20815
20816 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20817
20818 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20819 "Ta" can never be negative.
20820
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020821 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20822 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020823 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20824 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020825 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020826
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020827 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020828
20829 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020830 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20831 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020832
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020833 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20834 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20835 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20836 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20837 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20838 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20839 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20840 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20841
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020842These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20843protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20844that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020845due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20846"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20847that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020848
20849Most common cases :
20850
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020851 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20852 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20853 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20854 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20855 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020856 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020857 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20858 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20859 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20860 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20861 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020862 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020863
20864 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20865 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20866 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20867 of ms on remote networks.
20868
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020869 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20870 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20871 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020872
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020873 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20874 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020875 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020876 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20877 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20878 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20879 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20880 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20881 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020882
20883Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20884
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020885 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020886 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020887 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020888
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020889 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020890 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20891 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20892
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020893 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020894 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20895 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20896 flags.
20897
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020898 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20899 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020900 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20901 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20902 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20903 the client connection was maintained open.
20904
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020905 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020906 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020907 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020908 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20909
20910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209118.5. Session state at disconnection
20912-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020913
20914TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20915"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
209162-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20917each of which has a special meaning :
20918
20919 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20920 session to terminate :
20921
20922 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20923
20924 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20925 server explicitly refused it.
20926
20927 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20928 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20929 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20930 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020931 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020932
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020933 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020934 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020935
20936 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20937 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20938 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20939 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20940 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20941
20942 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20943 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20944 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20945 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20946 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20947
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020948 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020949 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20950
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020951 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020952 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20953 backup connections when going up.
20954
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020955 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020956
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020957 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20958 send or receive data.
20959
20960 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20961 send or receive data.
20962
20963 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20964 with nothing left in the buffers.
20965
20966 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20967
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020968 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020969 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20970
20971 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20972 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20973 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20974 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20975 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20976
20977 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20978 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20979
20980 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20981 server (HTTP only).
20982
20983 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20984
20985 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20986 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20987 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20988
20989 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20990 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20991 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20992
20993 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20994
20995 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20996 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20997
20998 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20999 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21000 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21001
21002 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21003 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021004 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21005 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021006
21007 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21008 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21009 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21010 another server.
21011
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021012 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021013 server.
21014
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021015 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21016 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21017 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21018 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21019
21020 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21021 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21022 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21023 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21024
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021025 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21026 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21027 "use-server" rule).
21028
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021029 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21030
21031 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21032 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21033
21034 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21035
21036 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21037 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21038 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21039
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021040 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21041 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021042 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021043 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21044 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21045
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021046 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21047
21048 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21049 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21050
21051 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21052
21053 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21054
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021055The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21056was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021057helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21058starvation, attacks, etc...
21059
21060The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21061alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21062easier finding and understanding.
21063
21064 Flags Reason
21065
21066 -- Normal termination.
21067
21068 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021069 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21070 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21072
21073 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21074 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021075 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21076 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021077 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21078 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021080 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21081 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021082 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021083
21084 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21085 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21086 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21087
21088 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21089 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21090 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21091 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21092 the server takes too long to respond.
21093
21094 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21095 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21096 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21097 long a time to respond.
21098
21099 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21100 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21101 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021102 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021103 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21104 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021105
21106 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21107 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21108 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21109 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21110 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021111 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021112 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21113 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21114 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21115 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21116 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21117 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21118 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21119 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021120 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021121 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21122 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21123 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021124
21125 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21126 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021127 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21128 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21129 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21130 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021131
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021132 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021133 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21134
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021135 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021136 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21137 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021138 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021139 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21140 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21141
21142 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21143 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21144 503 or 504 here.
21145
21146 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021147 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021148 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21149 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21150 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21151
21152 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21153 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021154 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021156 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021157
21158 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21159 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21160 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21161 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21162 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21163 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021164 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021165
21166 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21167 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21168 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21169 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21170 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21171 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21172 solution is to fix the application.
21173
21174 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21175 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21176 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21177 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21178 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21179 external attacks.
21180
21181 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021182 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021183 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021184 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21185 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21186
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021187 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21188 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21189 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021190 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021191 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021192
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021193 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21194 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21195 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21196 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021197 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21198 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21199 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21200 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21201 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021202
21203 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21204 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21205 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21206 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21207
21208 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21209 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21210 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21211 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21212
21213 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21214 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21215 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21216 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21217
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021218The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021219persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021220important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21221re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21222
21223 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21224
21225 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21226 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21227 set on a GET request.
21228
21229 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21230 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021231 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021232 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21233
21234 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21235 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21236 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21237
21238 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21239 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21240 already got a cookie.
21241
21242 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21243 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21244 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21245 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21246 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21247
21248 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21249 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21250 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21251
21252 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21253 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21254 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21255
21256 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21257 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21258
21259 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21260 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21261 then advertised in the response.
21262
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212648.6. Non-printable characters
21265-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021266
21267In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21268consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21269converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21270prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21271being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21272escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21273is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21274'}' when logging headers.
21275
21276Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21277issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21278containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21279
21280Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21281the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21282performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21283
21284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212858.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21286---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021287
21288Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21289achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021290section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021291cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21292the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21293the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021294locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021295not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21296user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21297a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21298wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21299
21300 Examples :
21301 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21302 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21303
21304 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21305 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21306
21307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21309---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021310
21311Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21312proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21313the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21314server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21315
21316Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21317response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021318section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021319
21320It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021321time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21322appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021323are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21324and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21325follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21326request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21327in the logs.
21328
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021329As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21330frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21331an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21332
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021333 Example :
21334 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21335 listen proxy-out
21336 mode http
21337 option httplog
21338 option logasap
21339 log global
21340 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21341
21342 # log the name of the virtual server
21343 capture request header Host len 20
21344
21345 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21346 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21347
21348 # log the beginning of the referrer
21349 capture request header Referer len 20
21350
21351 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21352 capture response header Server len 20
21353
21354 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21355 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21356
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021357 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021358 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21359
21360 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21361 capture response header Via len 20
21362
21363 # log the URL location during a redirection
21364 capture response header Location len 20
21365
21366 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21367 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21368 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21369 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21370 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21371
21372 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21373 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21374 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21375 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021376 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021377
21378 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21379 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21380 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21381 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21382 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021383 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021384
21385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213868.9. Examples of logs
21387---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021388
21389These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21390them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21391reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21392
21393 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21394 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21395 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21396
21397 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21398 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21399
21400 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21401 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21402 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21403
21404 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21405 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21406
21407 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21408 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21409 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21410
21411 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021412 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021413 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21414 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21415
21416 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21417 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21418 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21419
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021420 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21421 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21422 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21423 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021424 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021425 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021426
21427 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021428 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021429
21430 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21431 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21432 Nothing was sent to any server.
21433
21434 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21435 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21436
21437 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21438 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021439 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021440 send a 408 return code to the client.
21441
21442 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21443 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21444
21445 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21446 5 seconds ("c----").
21447
21448 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21449 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021450 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021451
21452 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021453 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021454 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21455 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21456 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21457 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21458 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021459
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021460
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200214619. Supported filters
21462--------------------
21463
21464Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21465accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21466unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21467
21468See also : "filter"
21469
214709.1. Trace
21471----------
21472
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021473filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021474
21475 Arguments:
21476 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21477 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21478
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021479 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021480
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021481 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021482 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21483 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21484 amount of the parsed data.
21485
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021486 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021487
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021488This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21489callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21490information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21491filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21492
21493Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21494tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21495a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21496
21497
214989.2. HTTP compression
21499---------------------
21500
21501filter compression
21502
21503The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21504keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021505when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21506fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21507done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21508explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21509filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21510listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21511order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021512
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021513See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21514 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021515
21516
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200215179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21518--------------------------------------------
21519
21520filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21521
21522 Arguments :
21523
21524 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21525 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21526 parsed.
21527
21528 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21529 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21530 part must be placed in its own scope.
21531
21532The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21533external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021534streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021535exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21536also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21537
21538SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21539the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21540
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021541For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021542"doc/SPOE.txt".
21543
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100215449.4. Cache
21545----------
21546
21547filter cache <name>
21548
21549 Arguments :
21550
21551 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21552
21553The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21554"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021555cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021556other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21557case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21558is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21559filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021560listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21561order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021562
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021563See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21564 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21565
21566
215679.5. Fcgi-app
21568-------------
21569
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021570filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021571
21572 Arguments :
21573
21574 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21575
21576The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21577request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21578reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21579used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21580implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21581used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21582fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21583used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21584order.
21585
21586See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21587 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21588
21589
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215909.6. OpenTracing
21591----------------
21592
21593The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21594HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21595of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21596Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021598This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021599
21600The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21601HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21602participates in the work of HAProxy.
21603
21604filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21605
21606 Arguments :
21607
21608 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21609 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21610 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21611 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21612 OpenTracing filters.
21613
21614 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21615 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21616 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21617 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21618 filter must have its own scope defined.
21619
21620More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021621of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021622
21623
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002162410. FastCGI applications
21625-------------------------
21626
21627HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21628feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21629the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21630FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21631servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21632FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21633backend.
21634
21635HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21636application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21637connection.
21638
2163910.1. Setup
21640-----------
21641
2164210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21643--------------------------
21644
21645fcgi-app <name>
21646 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21647 document root must be defined.
21648
21649acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21650 Declare or complete an access list.
21651
21652 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21653 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21654 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21655 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21656 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21657
21658docroot <path>
21659 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21660 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21661 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21662
21663index <script-name>
21664 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21665 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21666 is an optional setting.
21667
21668 Example :
21669 index index.php
21670
21671log-stderr global
21672log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021673 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021674 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21675
21676 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21677 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21678
21679pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21680 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21681 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21682 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21683
21684 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21685 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21686 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21687 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21688
21689 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21690 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21691
21692path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021693 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021694 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21695 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21696 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21697 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21698 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21699 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21700 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021701
21702 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021703 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021704 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21705 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21706 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21707 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021708
21709 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021710 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21711 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021712
21713option get-values
21714no option get-values
21715 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21716
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021717 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021718 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21719
21720 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21721 application will accept.
21722
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021723 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21724 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021725
21726 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021727 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021728 option is disabled.
21729
21730 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21731 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21732 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21733 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21734 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21735 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21736
21737option keep-conn
21738no option keep-conn
21739 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21740 sending a response.
21741
21742 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21743 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21744
21745option max-reqs <reqs>
21746 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21747 accept.
21748
21749 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21750 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21751 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21752 to 1.
21753
21754option mpxs-conns
21755no option mpxs-conns
21756 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21757
21758 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21759 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21760
21761set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21762 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21763 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21764 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21765 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21766
21767 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21768 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21769 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21770
21771 Example :
21772 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21773 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21774
21775 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21776
21777
2177810.1.2. Proxy section
21779---------------------
21780
21781use-fcgi-app <name>
21782 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21783
21784 Arguments :
21785 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21786
21787 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21788 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21789 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21790 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21791 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21792
21793 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21794 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21795 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21796 application are evaluated.
21797
21798
2179910.1.3. Example
21800---------------
21801
21802 frontend front-http
21803 mode http
21804 bind *:80
21805 bind *:
21806
21807 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21808 default_backend back-static
21809
21810 backend back-static
21811 mode http
21812 server www A.B.C.D:80
21813
21814 backend back-dynamic
21815 mode http
21816 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21817 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21818
21819 fcgi-app php-fpm
21820 log-stderr global
21821 option keep-conn
21822
21823 docroot /var/www/my-app
21824 index index.php
21825 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21826
21827
2182810.2. Default parameters
21829------------------------
21830
21831A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21832the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021833script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021834applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21835
21836 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21837 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21838 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21839 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21840 | | |
21841 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21842 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21843 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21844 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21845 | | application. |
21846 | | |
21847 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21848 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21849 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21850 | | |
21851 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21852 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21853 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21854 | | the application's configuration. |
21855 | | |
21856 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21857 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21858 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21859 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21860 | | |
21861 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21862 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21863 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21864 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21865 | | be defined. |
21866 | | |
21867 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21868 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21869 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21870 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21871 | | is not set too. |
21872 | | |
21873 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21874 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21875 | | set. |
21876 | | |
21877 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21878 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21879 | | the request. |
21880 | | |
21881 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21882 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21883 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21884 | | |
21885 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21886 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21887 | | script to process the request. |
21888 | | |
21889 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21890 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21891 | | |
21892 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21893 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21894 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21895 | | |
21896 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21897 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21898 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21899 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21900 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21901 | | |
21902 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21903 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21904 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21905 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21906 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21907 | | side. |
21908 | | |
21909 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21910 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21911 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21912 | | connected to. |
21913 | | |
21914 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21915 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21916 | | |
21917 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020021918 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
21919 | | current HAProxy version. |
21920 | | |
21921 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021922 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21923 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21924 | | |
21925 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21926
21927
2192810.3. Limitations
21929------------------
21930
21931The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21932way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21933during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21934establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21935application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21936or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21937message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21938these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21939and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21940
21941Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21942request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21943requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21944
21945About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21946into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21947fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21948"http-request" ones.
21949
21950Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21951FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21952processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21953must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21954here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021955
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021956
2195711. Address formats
21958-------------------
21959
21960Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21961address.
21962
21963This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21964The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21965of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21966equivalent is '::'.
21967
21968Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21969is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21970
21971This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21972family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21973
21974Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21975configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21976use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21977'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21978
21979Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21980socket type and the transport method.
21981
21982
2198311.1 Address family prefixes
21984----------------------------
21985
21986'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21987
21988'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21989 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21990 listening.
21991
21992'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21993 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21994 on the statement using this address, a port or
21995 a port range may or must be specified.
21996
21997'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21998 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21999 using this address, a port or a port range
22000 may or must be specified.
22001
22002'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22003 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22004 using this address, a port or a port range
22005 may or must be specified.
22006
22007'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22008 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22009 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22010 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22011 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22012 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22013
22014'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22015 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22016 start by slash '/'.
22017
22018
2201911.2 Socket type prefixes
22020-------------------------
22021
22022Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22023type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22024this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22025This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22026but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22027
22028Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22029instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22030
22031If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22032they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22033report this to the maintainers.
22034
22035'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22036 to "stream"
22037
22038'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22039 to "datagram".
22040
22041
2204211.3 Protocol prefixes
22043----------------------
22044
22045'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22046 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22047 socket type and transport method is forced to
22048 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22049 this address, a port or a port range can or
22050 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22051 of 'stream+ip@'.
22052
22053'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22054 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22055 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22056 statement using this address, a port or port
22057 range can or must be specified.
22058 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22059
22060'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22061 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22062 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22063 statement using this address, a port or port
22064 range can or must be specified.
22065 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22066
22067'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22068 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22069 socket type and transport method is forced to
22070 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22071 this address, a port or a port range can or
22072 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22073 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22074
22075'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22076 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22077 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22078 the statement using this address, a port or
22079 port range can or must be specified.
22080 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22081
22082'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22083 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22084 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22085 the statement using this address, a port or
22086 port range can or must be specified.
22087 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22088
22089'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22090 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22091 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22092
22093'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22094 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22095 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22096
22097In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22098QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22099
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022100/*
22101 * Local variables:
22102 * fill-column: 79
22103 * End:
22104 */